pngvalid.c 315.0 KB
Newer Older
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1 2 3

/* pngvalid.c - validate libpng by constructing then reading png files.
 *
4
 * Last changed in libpng 1.6.9 [(PENDING RELEASE)]
5
 * Copyright (c) 2013 Glenn Randers-Pehrson
6
 * Written by John Cunningham Bowler
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
 *
 * This code is released under the libpng license.
 * For conditions of distribution and use, see the disclaimer
 * and license in png.h
 *
 * NOTES:
 *   This is a C program that is intended to be linked against libpng.  It
 *   generates bitmaps internally, stores them as PNG files (using the
 *   sequential write code) then reads them back (using the sequential
 *   read code) and validates that the result has the correct data.
 *
 *   The program can be modified and extended to test the correctness of
 *   transformations performed by libpng.
 */

22
#define _POSIX_SOURCE 1
23 24 25 26
#define _ISOC99_SOURCE 1 /* For floating point */
#define _GNU_SOURCE 1 /* For the floating point exception extension */

#include <signal.h>
27
#include <stdio.h>
28

29
#if defined(HAVE_CONFIG_H) && !defined(PNG_NO_CONFIG_H)
30 31
#  include <config.h>
#endif
32

33
#ifdef HAVE_FEENABLEEXCEPT /* from config.h, if included */
34 35
#  include <fenv.h>
#endif
36

37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44
/* Define the following to use this test against your installed libpng, rather
 * than the one being built here:
 */
#ifdef PNG_FREESTANDING_TESTS
#  include <png.h>
#else
#  include "../../png.h"
#endif
45

46 47 48 49
/* pngvalid requires write support and one of the fixed or floating point APIs.
 */
#if defined(PNG_WRITE_SUPPORTED) &&\
   (defined(PNG_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED) || defined(PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED))
50

51
#if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10500
52
/* This deliberately lacks the PNG_CONST. */
53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76
typedef png_byte *png_const_bytep;

/* This is copied from 1.5.1 png.h: */
#define PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7_PASSES 7
#define PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass) (((1U&~(pass))<<(3-((pass)>>1)))&7)
#define PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass) (((1U& (pass))<<(3-(((pass)+1)>>1)))&7)
#define PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass) ((pass)>2?(8-(pass))>>1:3)
#define PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass) ((pass)>1?(7-(pass))>>1:3)
#define PNG_PASS_ROWS(height, pass) (((height)+(((1<<PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass))\
   -1)-PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass)))>>PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass))
#define PNG_PASS_COLS(width, pass) (((width)+(((1<<PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass))\
   -1)-PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass)))>>PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass))
#define PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(yIn, pass) \
   (((yIn)<<PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass))+PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass))
#define PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(xIn, pass) \
   (((xIn)<<PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass))+PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass))
#define PNG_PASS_MASK(pass,off) ( \
   ((0x110145AFU>>(((7-(off))-(pass))<<2)) & 0xFU) | \
   ((0x01145AF0U>>(((7-(off))-(pass))<<2)) & 0xF0U))
#define PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass) \
   ((PNG_PASS_MASK(pass,0) >> ((y)&7)) & 1)
#define PNG_COL_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(x, pass) \
   ((PNG_PASS_MASK(pass,1) >> ((x)&7)) & 1)

77
/* These are needed too for the default build: */
78 79
#define PNG_WRITE_16BIT_SUPPORTED
#define PNG_READ_16BIT_SUPPORTED
80 81

/* This comes from pnglibconf.h afer 1.5: */
82
#define PNG_FP_1 100000
83
#define PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD_FIXED\
84
   ((png_fixed_point)(PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD * PNG_FP_1))
85 86
#endif

87 88 89 90
#if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10600
   /* 1.6.0 constifies many APIs, the following exists to allow pngvalid to be
    * compiled against earlier versions.
    */
91
#  define png_const_structp png_structp
92 93
#endif

94
#include <zlib.h>   /* For crc32 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
95

96
#include <float.h>  /* For floating point constants */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
97 98 99 100
#include <stdlib.h> /* For malloc */
#include <string.h> /* For memcpy, memset */
#include <math.h>   /* For floor */

101 102 103 104
/* Unused formal parameter errors are removed using the following macro which is
 * expected to have no bad effects on performance.
 */
#ifndef UNUSED
105 106 107 108 109
#  if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(_MSC_VER)
#     define UNUSED(param) (void)param;
#  else
#     define UNUSED(param)
#  endif
110 111
#endif

112 113 114 115 116
/* Fixups for various minimal builds */
#ifndef PNG_ERROR_TEXT_SUPPORTED
#  define png_error(a,b) png_err(a)
#endif

117
/***************************** EXCEPTION HANDLING *****************************/
118 119 120 121 122
#ifdef PNG_FREESTANDING_TESTS
#  include <cexcept.h>
#else
#  include "../visupng/cexcept.h"
#endif
123 124 125 126 127 128 129 130 131

#ifdef __cplusplus
#  define this not_the_cpp_this
#  define new not_the_cpp_new
#  define voidcast(type, value) static_cast<type>(value)
#else
#  define voidcast(type, value) (value)
#endif /* __cplusplus */

132
struct png_store;
133 134
define_exception_type(struct png_store*);

135
/* The following are macros to reduce typing everywhere where the well known
136 137
 * name 'the_exception_context' must be defined.
 */
138 139 140
#define anon_context(ps) struct exception_context *the_exception_context = \
   &(ps)->exception_context
#define context(ps,fault) anon_context(ps); png_store *fault
141

142 143 144 145 146 147 148
/******************************* UTILITIES ************************************/
/* Error handling is particularly problematic in production code - error
 * handlers often themselves have bugs which lead to programs that detect
 * minor errors crashing.  The following functions deal with one very
 * common class of errors in error handlers - attempting to format error or
 * warning messages into buffers that are too small.
 */
149 150
static size_t safecat(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos,
   PNG_CONST char *cat)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
151
{
152 153 154 155 156 157
   while (pos < bufsize && cat != NULL && *cat != 0)
      buffer[pos++] = *cat++;

   if (pos >= bufsize)
      pos = bufsize-1;

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
158 159 160 161 162 163 164 165 166 167 168
   buffer[pos] = 0;
   return pos;
}

static size_t safecatn(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos, int n)
{
   char number[64];
   sprintf(number, "%d", n);
   return safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, number);
}

169
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
170
static size_t safecatd(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos, double d,
171
    int precision)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
172 173 174 175 176
{
   char number[64];
   sprintf(number, "%.*f", precision, d);
   return safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, number);
}
177
#endif
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
178

179 180
static PNG_CONST char invalid[] = "invalid";
static PNG_CONST char sep[] = ": ";
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
181

182
static PNG_CONST char *colour_types[8] =
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
183
{
184 185
   "grayscale", invalid, "truecolour", "indexed-colour",
   "grayscale with alpha", invalid, "truecolour with alpha", invalid
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
186 187
};

188
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
189 190 191 192 193 194 195
/* Convert a double precision value to fixed point. */
static png_fixed_point
fix(double d)
{
   d = floor(d * PNG_FP_1 + .5);
   return (png_fixed_point)d;
}
196
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
197

198 199 200 201
/* Generate random bytes.  This uses a boring repeatable algorithm and it
 * is implemented here so that it gives the same set of numbers on every
 * architecture.  It's a linear congruential generator (Knuth or Sedgewick
 * "Algorithms") but it comes from the 'feedback taps' table in Horowitz and
202 203
 * Hill, "The Art of Electronics" (Pseudo-Random Bit Sequences and Noise
 * Generation.)
204 205 206
 */
static void
make_random_bytes(png_uint_32* seed, void* pv, size_t size)
207
{
208
   png_uint_32 u0 = seed[0], u1 = seed[1];
209
   png_bytep bytes = voidcast(png_bytep, pv);
210

211 212 213 214 215 216 217 218 219 220 221 222 223 224
   /* There are thirty three bits, the next bit in the sequence is bit-33 XOR
    * bit-20.  The top 1 bit is in u1, the bottom 32 are in u0.
    */
   size_t i;
   for (i=0; i<size; ++i)
   {
      /* First generate 8 new bits then shift them in at the end. */
      png_uint_32 u = ((u0 >> (20-8)) ^ ((u1 << 7) | (u0 >> (32-7)))) & 0xff;
      u1 <<= 8;
      u1 |= u0 >> 24;
      u0 <<= 8;
      u0 |= u;
      *bytes++ = (png_byte)u;
   }
225

226 227 228
   seed[0] = u0;
   seed[1] = u1;
}
229

230 231 232 233 234
static void
make_four_random_bytes(png_uint_32* seed, png_bytep bytes)
{
   make_random_bytes(seed, bytes, 4);
}
235

236
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
237 238 239 240 241
static void
randomize(void *pv, size_t size)
{
   static png_uint_32 random_seed[2] = {0x56789abc, 0xd};
   make_random_bytes(random_seed, pv, size);
242 243
}

244 245
#define RANDOMIZE(this) randomize(&(this), sizeof (this))

246 247 248 249 250 251 252 253 254 255
static unsigned int
random_mod(unsigned int max)
{
   unsigned int x;

   RANDOMIZE(x);

   return x % max; /* 0 .. max-1 */
}

256
#ifdef PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED
257 258 259 260 261 262 263 264 265
static int
random_choice(void)
{
   unsigned char x;

   RANDOMIZE(x);

   return x & 1;
}
266 267
#endif
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
268

269 270
/* A numeric ID based on PNG file characteristics.  The 'do_interlace' field
 * simply records whether pngvalid did the interlace itself or whether it
271 272
 * was done by libpng.  Width and height must be less than 256.  'palette' is an
 * index of the palette to use for formats with a palette (0 otherwise.)
273
 */
274 275
#define FILEID(col, depth, palette, interlace, width, height, do_interlace) \
   ((png_uint_32)((col) + ((depth)<<3) + ((palette)<<8) + ((interlace)<<13) + \
276 277
    (((do_interlace)!=0)<<15) + ((width)<<16) + ((height)<<24)))

278 279
#define COL_FROM_ID(id) ((png_byte)((id)& 0x7U))
#define DEPTH_FROM_ID(id) ((png_byte)(((id) >> 3) & 0x1fU))
280
#define PALETTE_FROM_ID(id) (((id) >> 8) & 0x1f)
281
#define INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id) ((int)(((id) >> 13) & 0x3))
282 283 284
#define DO_INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id) ((int)(((id)>>15) & 1))
#define WIDTH_FROM_ID(id) (((id)>>16) & 0xff)
#define HEIGHT_FROM_ID(id) (((id)>>24) & 0xff)
285 286 287 288

/* Utility to construct a standard name for a standard image. */
static size_t
standard_name(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos, png_byte colour_type,
289
    int bit_depth, unsigned int npalette, int interlace_type,
290
    png_uint_32 w, png_uint_32 h, int do_interlace)
291 292
{
   pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, colour_types[colour_type]);
293 294 295 296 297 298
   if (npalette > 0)
   {
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "[");
      pos = safecatn(buffer, bufsize, pos, npalette);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "]");
   }
299
   pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, " ");
300
   pos = safecatn(buffer, bufsize, pos, bit_depth);
301
   pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, " bit");
302 303

   if (interlace_type != PNG_INTERLACE_NONE)
304
   {
305
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, " interlaced");
306 307 308 309 310 311
      if (do_interlace)
         pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "(pngvalid)");
      else
         pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "(libpng)");
   }

312 313 314 315 316 317 318
   if (w > 0 || h > 0)
   {
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, " ");
      pos = safecatn(buffer, bufsize, pos, w);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "x");
      pos = safecatn(buffer, bufsize, pos, h);
   }
319 320 321 322 323 324 325 326

   return pos;
}

static size_t
standard_name_from_id(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos, png_uint_32 id)
{
   return standard_name(buffer, bufsize, pos, COL_FROM_ID(id),
327
      DEPTH_FROM_ID(id), PALETTE_FROM_ID(id), INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id),
328
      WIDTH_FROM_ID(id), HEIGHT_FROM_ID(id), DO_INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id));
329 330
}

331 332 333 334 335 336 337 338 339 340 341 342 343 344 345 346 347
/* Convenience API and defines to list valid formats.  Note that 16 bit read and
 * write support is required to do 16 bit read tests (we must be able to make a
 * 16 bit image to test!)
 */
#ifdef PNG_WRITE_16BIT_SUPPORTED
#  define WRITE_BDHI 4
#  ifdef PNG_READ_16BIT_SUPPORTED
#     define READ_BDHI 4
#     define DO_16BIT
#  endif
#else
#  define WRITE_BDHI 3
#endif
#ifndef DO_16BIT
#  define READ_BDHI 3
#endif

348 349 350
/* The following defines the number of different palettes to generate for
 * each log bit depth of a colour type 3 standard image.
 */
351
#define PALETTE_COUNT(bit_depth) ((bit_depth) > 4 ? 1U : 16U)
352

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
353
static int
354 355
next_format(png_bytep colour_type, png_bytep bit_depth,
   unsigned int* palette_number)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
356 357 358
{
   if (*bit_depth == 0)
   {
359
      *colour_type = 0, *bit_depth = 1, *palette_number = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
360 361
      return 1;
   }
362

363 364 365 366 367 368 369 370 371
   if (*colour_type == 3)
   {
      /* Add multiple palettes for colour type 3. */
      if (++*palette_number < PALETTE_COUNT(*bit_depth))
         return 1;

      *palette_number = 0;
   }

372 373 374
   *bit_depth = (png_byte)(*bit_depth << 1);

   /* Palette images are restricted to 8 bit depth */
375 376 377 378 379
   if (*bit_depth <= 8
#     ifdef DO_16BIT
         || (*colour_type != 3 && *bit_depth <= 16)
#     endif
      )
380 381 382 383
      return 1;

   /* Move to the next color type, or return 0 at the end. */
   switch (*colour_type)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
384
   {
385 386 387 388 389 390 391 392 393 394 395 396 397 398 399 400 401 402 403 404 405 406
      case 0:
         *colour_type = 2;
         *bit_depth = 8;
         return 1;

      case 2:
         *colour_type = 3;
         *bit_depth = 1;
         return 1;

      case 3:
         *colour_type = 4;
         *bit_depth = 8;
         return 1;

      case 4:
         *colour_type = 6;
         *bit_depth = 8;
         return 1;

      default:
         return 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
407 408 409
   }
}

410
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
411
static unsigned int
412
sample(png_const_bytep row, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth,
413
    png_uint_32 x, unsigned int sample_index)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
414
{
415
   png_uint_32 bit_index, result;
416

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
417 418
   /* Find a sample index for the desired sample: */
   x *= bit_depth;
419
   bit_index = x;
420

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
421 422 423
   if ((colour_type & 1) == 0) /* !palette */
   {
      if (colour_type & 2)
424
         bit_index *= 3;
425 426

      if (colour_type & 4)
427
         bit_index += x; /* Alpha channel */
428

429
      /* Multiple channels; select one: */
430
      if (colour_type & (2+4))
431
         bit_index += sample_index * bit_depth;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
432 433 434
   }

   /* Return the sample from the row as an integer. */
435
   row += bit_index >> 3;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
436
   result = *row;
437

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
438 439
   if (bit_depth == 8)
      return result;
440

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
441 442
   else if (bit_depth > 8)
      return (result << 8) + *++row;
443

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
444
   /* Less than 8 bits per sample. */
445 446
   bit_index &= 7;
   return (result >> (8-bit_index-bit_depth)) & ((1U<<bit_depth)-1);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
447
}
448
#endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
449

450 451 452 453 454 455 456 457 458 459 460 461 462 463 464 465 466 467 468 469 470 471 472 473 474 475 476 477 478 479 480 481 482 483 484 485
/* Copy a single pixel, of a given size, from one buffer to another -
 * while this is basically bit addressed there is an implicit assumption
 * that pixels 8 or more bits in size are byte aligned and that pixels
 * do not otherwise cross byte boundaries.  (This is, so far as I know,
 * universally true in bitmap computer graphics.  [JCB 20101212])
 *
 * NOTE: The to and from buffers may be the same.
 */
static void
pixel_copy(png_bytep toBuffer, png_uint_32 toIndex,
   png_const_bytep fromBuffer, png_uint_32 fromIndex, unsigned int pixelSize)
{
   /* Assume we can multiply by 'size' without overflow because we are
    * just working in a single buffer.
    */
   toIndex *= pixelSize;
   fromIndex *= pixelSize;
   if (pixelSize < 8) /* Sub-byte */
   {
      /* Mask to select the location of the copied pixel: */
      unsigned int destMask = ((1U<<pixelSize)-1) << (8-pixelSize-(toIndex&7));
      /* The following read the entire pixels and clears the extra: */
      unsigned int destByte = toBuffer[toIndex >> 3] & ~destMask;
      unsigned int sourceByte = fromBuffer[fromIndex >> 3];

      /* Don't rely on << or >> supporting '0' here, just in case: */
      fromIndex &= 7;
      if (fromIndex > 0) sourceByte <<= fromIndex;
      if ((toIndex & 7) > 0) sourceByte >>= toIndex & 7;

      toBuffer[toIndex >> 3] = (png_byte)(destByte | (sourceByte & destMask));
   }
   else /* One or more bytes */
      memmove(toBuffer+(toIndex>>3), fromBuffer+(fromIndex>>3), pixelSize>>3);
}

486
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
487 488 489 490 491 492 493 494 495 496 497 498 499 500 501 502 503 504 505 506 507 508
/* Copy a complete row of pixels, taking into account potential partial
 * bytes at the end.
 */
static void
row_copy(png_bytep toBuffer, png_const_bytep fromBuffer, unsigned int bitWidth)
{
   memcpy(toBuffer, fromBuffer, bitWidth >> 3);

   if ((bitWidth & 7) != 0)
   {
      unsigned int mask;

      toBuffer += bitWidth >> 3;
      fromBuffer += bitWidth >> 3;
      /* The remaining bits are in the top of the byte, the mask is the bits to
       * retain.
       */
      mask = 0xff >> (bitWidth & 7);
      *toBuffer = (png_byte)((*toBuffer & mask) | (*fromBuffer & ~mask));
   }
}

509 510 511 512 513 514
/* Compare pixels - they are assumed to start at the first byte in the
 * given buffers.
 */
static int
pixel_cmp(png_const_bytep pa, png_const_bytep pb, png_uint_32 bit_width)
{
515
#if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10506
516 517 518 519 520 521 522 523 524 525 526 527 528 529 530 531 532 533 534 535
   if (memcmp(pa, pb, bit_width>>3) == 0)
   {
      png_uint_32 p;

      if ((bit_width & 7) == 0) return 0;

      /* Ok, any differences? */
      p = pa[bit_width >> 3];
      p ^= pb[bit_width >> 3];

      if (p == 0) return 0;

      /* There are, but they may not be significant, remove the bits
       * after the end (the low order bits in PNG.)
       */
      bit_width &= 7;
      p >>= 8-bit_width;

      if (p == 0) return 0;
   }
536 537 538 539 540 541 542
#else
   /* From libpng-1.5.6 the overwrite should be fixed, so compare the trailing
    * bits too:
    */
   if (memcmp(pa, pb, (bit_width+7)>>3) == 0)
      return 0;
#endif
543

544 545 546 547 548 549 550
   /* Return the index of the changed byte. */
   {
      png_uint_32 where = 0;

      while (pa[where] == pb[where]) ++where;
      return 1+where;
   }
551
}
552
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
553

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
554
/*************************** BASIC PNG FILE WRITING ***************************/
555
/* A png_store takes data from the sequential writer or provides data
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
556 557 558
 * to the sequential reader.  It can also store the result of a PNG
 * write for later retrieval.
 */
559 560
#define STORE_BUFFER_SIZE 500 /* arbitrary */
typedef struct png_store_buffer
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
561
{
562 563 564
   struct png_store_buffer*  prev;    /* NOTE: stored in reverse order */
   png_byte                  buffer[STORE_BUFFER_SIZE];
} png_store_buffer;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
565

566 567
#define FILE_NAME_SIZE 64

568 569 570 571 572 573 574 575
typedef struct store_palette_entry /* record of a single palette entry */
{
   png_byte red;
   png_byte green;
   png_byte blue;
   png_byte alpha;
} store_palette_entry, store_palette[256];

576
typedef struct png_store_file
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
577
{
578
   struct png_store_file*  next;      /* as many as you like... */
579
   char                    name[FILE_NAME_SIZE];
580
   png_uint_32             id;        /* must be correct (see FILEID) */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
581
   png_size_t              datacount; /* In this (the last) buffer */
582
   png_store_buffer        data;      /* Last buffer in file */
583 584
   int                     npalette;  /* Number of entries in palette */
   store_palette_entry*    palette;   /* May be NULL */
585
} png_store_file;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
586

587 588 589 590 591 592 593 594 595 596 597 598 599 600 601 602 603 604 605 606 607
/* The following is a pool of memory allocated by a single libpng read or write
 * operation.
 */
typedef struct store_pool
{
   struct png_store    *store;   /* Back pointer */
   struct store_memory *list;    /* List of allocated memory */
   png_byte             mark[4]; /* Before and after data */

   /* Statistics for this run. */
   png_alloc_size_t     max;     /* Maximum single allocation */
   png_alloc_size_t     current; /* Current allocation */
   png_alloc_size_t     limit;   /* Highest current allocation */
   png_alloc_size_t     total;   /* Total allocation */

   /* Overall statistics (retained across successive runs). */
   png_alloc_size_t     max_max;
   png_alloc_size_t     max_limit;
   png_alloc_size_t     max_total;
} store_pool;

608
typedef struct png_store
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
609
{
610 611 612 613 614 615 616
   /* For cexcept.h exception handling - simply store one of these;
    * the context is a self pointer but it may point to a different
    * png_store (in fact it never does in this program.)
    */
   struct exception_context
                      exception_context;

617 618
   unsigned int       verbose :1;
   unsigned int       treat_warnings_as_errors :1;
619 620 621
   unsigned int       expect_error :1;
   unsigned int       expect_warning :1;
   unsigned int       saw_warning :1;
622
   unsigned int       speed :1;
623 624
   unsigned int       progressive :1; /* use progressive read */
   unsigned int       validated :1;   /* used as a temporary flag */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
625 626
   int                nerrors;
   int                nwarnings;
627 628 629 630 631 632
   int                noptions;       /* number of options below: */
   struct {
      unsigned char   option;         /* option number, 0..30 */
      unsigned char   setting;        /* setting (unset,invalid,on,off) */
   }                  options[16];
   char               test[128];      /* Name of test */
633
   char               error[256];
634

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
635 636 637
   /* Read fields */
   png_structp        pread;    /* Used to read a saved file */
   png_infop          piread;
638 639
   png_store_file*    current;  /* Set when reading */
   png_store_buffer*  next;     /* Set when reading */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
640
   png_size_t         readpos;  /* Position in *next */
641
   png_byte*          image;    /* Buffer for reading interlaced images */
642 643 644
   png_size_t         cb_image; /* Size of this buffer */
   png_size_t         cb_row;   /* Row size of the image(s) */
   png_uint_32        image_h;  /* Number of rows in a single image */
645
   store_pool         read_memory_pool;
646

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
647
   /* Write fields */
648
   png_store_file*    saved;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
649 650 651
   png_structp        pwrite;   /* Used when writing a new file */
   png_infop          piwrite;
   png_size_t         writepos; /* Position in .new */
652
   char               wname[FILE_NAME_SIZE];
653
   png_store_buffer   new;      /* The end of the new PNG file being written. */
654
   store_pool         write_memory_pool;
655 656
   store_palette_entry* palette;
   int                  npalette;
657
} png_store;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
658 659

/* Initialization and cleanup */
660
static void
661
store_pool_mark(png_bytep mark)
662
{
663
   static png_uint_32 store_seed[2] = { 0x12345678, 1};
664

665
   make_four_random_bytes(store_seed, mark);
666 667
}

668
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
669
/* Use this for random 32 bit values; this function makes sure the result is
670 671 672 673 674 675 676 677 678 679 680 681 682 683 684 685 686 687
 * non-zero.
 */
static png_uint_32
random_32(void)
{

   for(;;)
   {
      png_byte mark[4];
      png_uint_32 result;

      store_pool_mark(mark);
      result = png_get_uint_32(mark);

      if (result != 0)
         return result;
   }
}
688
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
689

690 691 692 693 694 695 696 697 698 699 700 701
static void
store_pool_init(png_store *ps, store_pool *pool)
{
   memset(pool, 0, sizeof *pool);

   pool->store = ps;
   pool->list = NULL;
   pool->max = pool->current = pool->limit = pool->total = 0;
   pool->max_max = pool->max_limit = pool->max_total = 0;
   store_pool_mark(pool->mark);
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
702
static void
703
store_init(png_store* ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
704 705
{
   memset(ps, 0, sizeof *ps);
706 707 708
   init_exception_context(&ps->exception_context);
   store_pool_init(ps, &ps->read_memory_pool);
   store_pool_init(ps, &ps->write_memory_pool);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
709 710
   ps->verbose = 0;
   ps->treat_warnings_as_errors = 0;
711 712 713
   ps->expect_error = 0;
   ps->expect_warning = 0;
   ps->saw_warning = 0;
714
   ps->speed = 0;
715
   ps->progressive = 0;
716
   ps->validated = 0;
717
   ps->nerrors = ps->nwarnings = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
718 719 720 721 722
   ps->pread = NULL;
   ps->piread = NULL;
   ps->saved = ps->current = NULL;
   ps->next = NULL;
   ps->readpos = 0;
723 724
   ps->image = NULL;
   ps->cb_image = 0;
725 726
   ps->cb_row = 0;
   ps->image_h = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
727 728 729 730
   ps->pwrite = NULL;
   ps->piwrite = NULL;
   ps->writepos = 0;
   ps->new.prev = NULL;
731 732
   ps->palette = NULL;
   ps->npalette = 0;
733
   ps->noptions = 0;
734 735
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
736
static void
737
store_freebuffer(png_store_buffer* psb)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
738 739 740
{
   if (psb->prev)
   {
741
      store_freebuffer(psb->prev);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
742 743 744 745 746 747
      free(psb->prev);
      psb->prev = NULL;
   }
}

static void
748
store_freenew(png_store *ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
749
{
750
   store_freebuffer(&ps->new);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
751
   ps->writepos = 0;
752 753 754 755 756 757
   if (ps->palette != NULL)
   {
      free(ps->palette);
      ps->palette = NULL;
      ps->npalette = 0;
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
758 759 760
}

static void
761
store_storenew(png_store *ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
762
{
763
   png_store_buffer *pb;
764

765
   if (ps->writepos != STORE_BUFFER_SIZE)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
766
      png_error(ps->pwrite, "invalid store call");
767

768
   pb = voidcast(png_store_buffer*, malloc(sizeof *pb));
769

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
770 771
   if (pb == NULL)
      png_error(ps->pwrite, "store new: OOM");
772

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
773 774 775 776 777 778
   *pb = ps->new;
   ps->new.prev = pb;
   ps->writepos = 0;
}

static void
779
store_freefile(png_store_file **ppf)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
780
{
781 782 783
   if (*ppf != NULL)
   {
      store_freefile(&(*ppf)->next);
784

785 786
      store_freebuffer(&(*ppf)->data);
      (*ppf)->datacount = 0;
787 788 789 790 791 792
      if ((*ppf)->palette != NULL)
      {
         free((*ppf)->palette);
         (*ppf)->palette = NULL;
         (*ppf)->npalette = 0;
      }
793 794 795
      free(*ppf);
      *ppf = NULL;
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
796 797 798
}

/* Main interface to file storeage, after writing a new PNG file (see the API
799
 * below) call store_storefile to store the result with the given name and id.
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
800 801
 */
static void
802
store_storefile(png_store *ps, png_uint_32 id)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
803
{
804
   png_store_file *pf = voidcast(png_store_file*, malloc(sizeof *pf));
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
805 806 807 808 809 810 811 812
   if (pf == NULL)
      png_error(ps->pwrite, "storefile: OOM");
   safecat(pf->name, sizeof pf->name, 0, ps->wname);
   pf->id = id;
   pf->data = ps->new;
   pf->datacount = ps->writepos;
   ps->new.prev = NULL;
   ps->writepos = 0;
813 814 815 816
   pf->palette = ps->palette;
   pf->npalette = ps->npalette;
   ps->palette = 0;
   ps->npalette = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
817 818 819 820 821 822 823 824

   /* And save it. */
   pf->next = ps->saved;
   ps->saved = pf;
}

/* Generate an error message (in the given buffer) */
static size_t
825
store_message(png_store *ps, png_const_structp pp, char *buffer, size_t bufsize,
826
   size_t pos, PNG_CONST char *msg)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
827
{
828
   if (pp != NULL && pp == ps->pread)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
829 830 831
   {
      /* Reading a file */
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "read: ");
832

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
833 834 835
      if (ps->current != NULL)
      {
         pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ps->current->name);
836
         pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, sep);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
837 838
      }
   }
839

840
   else if (pp != NULL && pp == ps->pwrite)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
841 842 843 844
   {
      /* Writing a file */
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "write: ");
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ps->wname);
845
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, sep);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
846
   }
847

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
848 849
   else
   {
850
      /* Neither reading nor writing (or a memory error in struct delete) */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
851 852 853
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "pngvalid: ");
   }

854 855 856 857 858
   if (ps->test[0] != 0)
   {
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ps->test);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, sep);
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
859 860 861 862
   pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, msg);
   return pos;
}

863 864
/* Verbose output to the error stream: */
static void
865
store_verbose(png_store *ps, png_const_structp pp, png_const_charp prefix,
866 867 868 869 870 871 872 873 874 875 876 877
   png_const_charp message)
{
   char buffer[512];

   if (prefix)
      fputs(prefix, stderr);

   (void)store_message(ps, pp, buffer, sizeof buffer, 0, message);
   fputs(buffer, stderr);
   fputc('\n', stderr);
}

878
/* Log an error or warning - the relevant count is always incremented. */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
879
static void
880 881
store_log(png_store* ps, png_const_structp pp, png_const_charp message,
   int is_error)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
882
{
883 884 885 886 887 888 889
   /* The warning is copied to the error buffer if there are no errors and it is
    * the first warning.  The error is copied to the error buffer if it is the
    * first error (overwriting any prior warnings).
    */
   if (is_error ? (ps->nerrors)++ == 0 :
       (ps->nwarnings)++ == 0 && ps->nerrors == 0)
      store_message(ps, pp, ps->error, sizeof ps->error, 0, message);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
890

891
   if (ps->verbose)
892
      store_verbose(ps, pp, is_error ? "error: " : "warning: ", message);
893
}
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
894

895
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
896 897 898 899 900 901 902 903 904 905 906 907
/* Internal error function, called with a png_store but no libpng stuff. */
static void
internal_error(png_store *ps, png_const_charp message)
{
   store_log(ps, NULL, message, 1 /* error */);

   /* And finally throw an exception. */
   {
      struct exception_context *the_exception_context = &ps->exception_context;
      Throw ps;
   }
}
908
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
909

910 911
/* Functions to use as PNG callbacks. */
static void
912
store_error(png_structp ppIn, png_const_charp message) /* PNG_NORETURN */
913
{
914
   png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
915
   png_store *ps = voidcast(png_store*, png_get_error_ptr(pp));
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
916

917
   if (!ps->expect_error)
918
      store_log(ps, pp, message, 1 /* error */);
919 920 921 922 923 924

   /* And finally throw an exception. */
   {
      struct exception_context *the_exception_context = &ps->exception_context;
      Throw ps;
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
925 926 927
}

static void
928
store_warning(png_structp ppIn, png_const_charp message)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
929
{
930
   png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
931
   png_store *ps = voidcast(png_store*, png_get_error_ptr(pp));
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
932

933
   if (!ps->expect_warning)
934
      store_log(ps, pp, message, 0 /* warning */);
935 936
   else
      ps->saw_warning = 1;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
937 938
}

939 940 941 942 943
/* These somewhat odd functions are used when reading an image to ensure that
 * the buffer is big enough, the png_structp is for errors.
 */
/* Return a single row from the correct image. */
static png_bytep
944
store_image_row(PNG_CONST png_store* ps, png_const_structp pp, int nImage,
945 946 947 948 949 950 951 952 953 954 955 956 957 958
   png_uint_32 y)
{
   png_size_t coffset = (nImage * ps->image_h + y) * (ps->cb_row + 5) + 2;

   if (ps->image == NULL)
      png_error(pp, "no allocated image");

   if (coffset + ps->cb_row + 3 > ps->cb_image)
      png_error(pp, "image too small");

   return ps->image + coffset;
}

static void
959
store_image_free(png_store *ps, png_const_structp pp)
960 961 962 963 964 965 966 967 968 969 970 971 972 973 974 975 976 977 978 979 980
{
   if (ps->image != NULL)
   {
      png_bytep image = ps->image;

      if (image[-1] != 0xed || image[ps->cb_image] != 0xfe)
      {
         if (pp != NULL)
            png_error(pp, "png_store image overwrite (1)");
         else
            store_log(ps, NULL, "png_store image overwrite (2)", 1);
      }

      ps->image = NULL;
      ps->cb_image = 0;
      --image;
      free(image);
   }
}

static void
981 982
store_ensure_image(png_store *ps, png_const_structp pp, int nImages,
   png_size_t cbRow, png_uint_32 cRows)
983 984 985 986 987 988 989 990 991 992
{
   png_size_t cb = nImages * cRows * (cbRow + 5);

   if (ps->cb_image < cb)
   {
      png_bytep image;

      store_image_free(ps, pp);

      /* The buffer is deliberately mis-aligned. */
993
      image = voidcast(png_bytep, malloc(cb+2));
994 995 996 997 998 999 1000 1001 1002 1003 1004 1005 1006 1007 1008 1009 1010 1011
      if (image == NULL)
      {
         /* Called from the startup - ignore the error for the moment. */
         if (pp == NULL)
            return;

         png_error(pp, "OOM allocating image buffer");
      }

      /* These magic tags are used to detect overwrites above. */
      ++image;
      image[-1] = 0xed;
      image[cb] = 0xfe;

      ps->image = image;
      ps->cb_image = cb;
   }

1012
   /* We have an adequate sized image; lay out the rows.  There are 2 bytes at
1013 1014
    * the start and three at the end of each (this ensures that the row
    * alignment starts out odd - 2+1 and changes for larger images on each row.)
1015 1016 1017 1018
    */
   ps->cb_row = cbRow;
   ps->image_h = cRows;

1019 1020 1021 1022 1023
   /* For error checking, the whole buffer is set to 10110010 (0xb2 - 178).
    * This deliberately doesn't match the bits in the size test image which are
    * outside the image; these are set to 0xff (all 1).  To make the row
    * comparison work in the 'size' test case the size rows are pre-initialized
    * to the same value prior to calling 'standard_row'.
1024
    */
1025
   memset(ps->image, 178, cb);
1026

1027
   /* Then put in the marks. */
1028 1029 1030 1031 1032 1033 1034 1035 1036 1037 1038 1039 1040 1041 1042 1043 1044 1045
   while (--nImages >= 0)
   {
      png_uint_32 y;

      for (y=0; y<cRows; ++y)
      {
         png_bytep row = store_image_row(ps, pp, nImages, y);

         /* The markers: */
         row[-2] = 190;
         row[-1] = 239;
         row[cbRow] = 222;
         row[cbRow+1] = 173;
         row[cbRow+2] = 17;
      }
   }
}

1046
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
1047
static void
1048
store_image_check(PNG_CONST png_store* ps, png_const_structp pp, int iImage)
1049 1050 1051 1052 1053 1054 1055 1056 1057 1058 1059 1060 1061 1062 1063 1064 1065 1066 1067 1068 1069 1070 1071 1072 1073 1074 1075
{
   png_const_bytep image = ps->image;

   if (image[-1] != 0xed || image[ps->cb_image] != 0xfe)
      png_error(pp, "image overwrite");
   else
   {
      png_size_t cbRow = ps->cb_row;
      png_uint_32 rows = ps->image_h;

      image += iImage * (cbRow+5) * ps->image_h;

      image += 2; /* skip image first row markers */

      while (rows-- > 0)
      {
         if (image[-2] != 190 || image[-1] != 239)
            png_error(pp, "row start overwritten");

         if (image[cbRow] != 222 || image[cbRow+1] != 173 ||
            image[cbRow+2] != 17)
            png_error(pp, "row end overwritten");

         image += cbRow+5;
      }
   }
}
1076
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
1077

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1078
static void
1079
store_write(png_structp ppIn, png_bytep pb, png_size_t st)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1080
{
1081
   png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
1082
   png_store *ps = voidcast(png_store*, png_get_io_ptr(pp));
1083

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1084
   if (ps->pwrite != pp)
1085
      png_error(pp, "store state damaged");
1086

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1087 1088 1089 1090
   while (st > 0)
   {
      size_t cb;

1091 1092
      if (ps->writepos >= STORE_BUFFER_SIZE)
         store_storenew(ps);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1093 1094

      cb = st;
1095

1096 1097
      if (cb > STORE_BUFFER_SIZE - ps->writepos)
         cb = STORE_BUFFER_SIZE - ps->writepos;
1098

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1099 1100 1101 1102 1103 1104 1105 1106
      memcpy(ps->new.buffer + ps->writepos, pb, cb);
      pb += cb;
      st -= cb;
      ps->writepos += cb;
   }
}

static void
1107
store_flush(png_structp ppIn)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1108
{
1109
   UNUSED(ppIn) /*DOES NOTHING*/
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1110 1111
}

1112
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1113
static size_t
1114
store_read_buffer_size(png_store *ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1115 1116 1117
{
   /* Return the bytes available for read in the current buffer. */
   if (ps->next != &ps->current->data)
1118
      return STORE_BUFFER_SIZE;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1119 1120 1121 1122

   return ps->current->datacount;
}

1123
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
1124 1125 1126 1127 1128 1129 1130 1131 1132 1133 1134 1135 1136 1137 1138 1139 1140 1141 1142 1143 1144 1145 1146 1147
/* Return total bytes available for read. */
static size_t
store_read_buffer_avail(png_store *ps)
{
   if (ps->current != NULL && ps->next != NULL)
   {
      png_store_buffer *next = &ps->current->data;
      size_t cbAvail = ps->current->datacount;

      while (next != ps->next && next != NULL)
      {
         next = next->prev;
         cbAvail += STORE_BUFFER_SIZE;
      }

      if (next != ps->next)
         png_error(ps->pread, "buffer read error");

      if (cbAvail > ps->readpos)
         return cbAvail - ps->readpos;
   }

   return 0;
}
1148
#endif
1149

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1150
static int
1151
store_read_buffer_next(png_store *ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1152
{
1153 1154
   png_store_buffer *pbOld = ps->next;
   png_store_buffer *pbNew = &ps->current->data;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1155 1156 1157 1158
   if (pbOld != pbNew)
   {
      while (pbNew != NULL && pbNew->prev != pbOld)
         pbNew = pbNew->prev;
1159

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1160 1161 1162
      if (pbNew != NULL)
      {
         ps->next = pbNew;
1163 1164
         ps->readpos = 0;
         return 1;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1165 1166 1167 1168 1169 1170 1171 1172
      }

      png_error(ps->pread, "buffer lost");
   }

   return 0; /* EOF or error */
}

1173 1174 1175
/* Need separate implementation and callback to allow use of the same code
 * during progressive read, where the io_ptr is set internally by libpng.
 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1176
static void
1177
store_read_imp(png_store *ps, png_bytep pb, png_size_t st)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1178
{
1179 1180
   if (ps->current == NULL || ps->next == NULL)
      png_error(ps->pread, "store state damaged");
1181

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1182 1183
   while (st > 0)
   {
1184
      size_t cbAvail = store_read_buffer_size(ps) - ps->readpos;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1185 1186 1187 1188

      if (cbAvail > 0)
      {
         if (cbAvail > st) cbAvail = st;
1189 1190 1191 1192
         memcpy(pb, ps->next->buffer + ps->readpos, cbAvail);
         st -= cbAvail;
         pb += cbAvail;
         ps->readpos += cbAvail;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1193
      }
1194

1195
      else if (!store_read_buffer_next(ps))
1196
         png_error(ps->pread, "read beyond end of file");
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1197 1198 1199
   }
}

1200
static void
1201
store_read(png_structp ppIn, png_bytep pb, png_size_t st)
1202
{
1203
   png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
1204
   png_store *ps = voidcast(png_store*, png_get_io_ptr(pp));
1205

1206 1207 1208 1209 1210 1211 1212 1213 1214
   if (ps == NULL || ps->pread != pp)
      png_error(pp, "bad store read call");

   store_read_imp(ps, pb, st);
}

static void
store_progressive_read(png_store *ps, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
1215 1216 1217 1218
   /* Notice that a call to store_read will cause this function to fail because
    * readpos will be set.
    */
   if (ps->pread != pp || ps->current == NULL || ps->next == NULL)
1219
      png_error(pp, "store state damaged (progressive)");
1220 1221 1222 1223 1224 1225 1226 1227 1228 1229

   do
   {
      if (ps->readpos != 0)
         png_error(pp, "store_read called during progressive read");

      png_process_data(pp, pi, ps->next->buffer, store_read_buffer_size(ps));
   }
   while (store_read_buffer_next(ps));
}
1230
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
1231

1232 1233 1234 1235 1236 1237 1238 1239 1240 1241 1242 1243 1244
/* The caller must fill this in: */
static store_palette_entry *
store_write_palette(png_store *ps, int npalette)
{
   if (ps->pwrite == NULL)
      store_log(ps, NULL, "attempt to write palette without write stream", 1);

   if (ps->palette != NULL)
      png_error(ps->pwrite, "multiple store_write_palette calls");

   /* This function can only return NULL if called with '0'! */
   if (npalette > 0)
   {
1245 1246
      ps->palette = voidcast(store_palette_entry*, malloc(npalette *
         sizeof *ps->palette));
1247 1248 1249 1250 1251 1252 1253 1254 1255 1256

      if (ps->palette == NULL)
         png_error(ps->pwrite, "store new palette: OOM");

      ps->npalette = npalette;
   }

   return ps->palette;
}

1257
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
1258 1259 1260 1261 1262 1263 1264 1265 1266 1267 1268 1269 1270
static store_palette_entry *
store_current_palette(png_store *ps, int *npalette)
{
   /* This is an internal error (the call has been made outside a read
    * operation.)
    */
   if (ps->current == NULL)
      store_log(ps, ps->pread, "no current stream for palette", 1);

   /* The result may be null if there is no palette. */
   *npalette = ps->current->npalette;
   return ps->current->palette;
}
1271
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
1272

1273
/***************************** MEMORY MANAGEMENT*** ***************************/
1274
#ifdef PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED
1275 1276 1277 1278 1279 1280 1281 1282 1283 1284 1285 1286 1287 1288 1289 1290 1291 1292 1293 1294
/* A store_memory is simply the header for an allocated block of memory.  The
 * pointer returned to libpng is just after the end of the header block, the
 * allocated memory is followed by a second copy of the 'mark'.
 */
typedef struct store_memory
{
   store_pool          *pool;    /* Originating pool */
   struct store_memory *next;    /* Singly linked list */
   png_alloc_size_t     size;    /* Size of memory allocated */
   png_byte             mark[4]; /* ID marker */
} store_memory;

/* Handle a fatal error in memory allocation.  This calls png_error if the
 * libpng struct is non-NULL, else it outputs a message and returns.  This means
 * that a memory problem while libpng is running will abort (png_error) the
 * handling of particular file while one in cleanup (after the destroy of the
 * struct has returned) will simply keep going and free (or attempt to free)
 * all the memory.
 */
static void
1295
store_pool_error(png_store *ps, png_const_structp pp, PNG_CONST char *msg)
1296 1297 1298 1299
{
   if (pp != NULL)
      png_error(pp, msg);

1300 1301 1302 1303
   /* Else we have to do it ourselves.  png_error eventually calls store_log,
    * above.  store_log accepts a NULL png_structp - it just changes what gets
    * output by store_message.
    */
1304
   store_log(ps, pp, msg, 1 /* error */);
1305 1306 1307
}

static void
1308
store_memory_free(png_const_structp pp, store_pool *pool, store_memory *memory)
1309 1310 1311 1312 1313 1314
{
   /* Note that pp may be NULL (see store_pool_delete below), the caller has
    * found 'memory' in pool->list *and* unlinked this entry, so this is a valid
    * pointer (for sure), but the contents may have been trashed.
    */
   if (memory->pool != pool)
1315
      store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "memory corrupted (pool)");
1316 1317

   else if (memcmp(memory->mark, pool->mark, sizeof memory->mark) != 0)
1318
      store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "memory corrupted (start)");
1319 1320 1321 1322 1323 1324 1325

   /* It should be safe to read the size field now. */
   else
   {
      png_alloc_size_t cb = memory->size;

      if (cb > pool->max)
1326
         store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "memory corrupted (size)");
1327 1328 1329

      else if (memcmp((png_bytep)(memory+1)+cb, pool->mark, sizeof pool->mark)
         != 0)
1330
         store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "memory corrupted (end)");
1331 1332 1333 1334 1335 1336 1337 1338 1339 1340 1341 1342 1343 1344 1345 1346 1347 1348 1349 1350 1351 1352 1353 1354 1355 1356 1357

      /* Finally give the library a chance to find problems too: */
      else
         {
         pool->current -= cb;
         free(memory);
         }
   }
}

static void
store_pool_delete(png_store *ps, store_pool *pool)
{
   if (pool->list != NULL)
   {
      fprintf(stderr, "%s: %s %s: memory lost (list follows):\n", ps->test,
         pool == &ps->read_memory_pool ? "read" : "write",
         pool == &ps->read_memory_pool ? (ps->current != NULL ?
            ps->current->name : "unknown file") : ps->wname);
      ++ps->nerrors;

      do
      {
         store_memory *next = pool->list;
         pool->list = next->next;
         next->next = NULL;

1358
         fprintf(stderr, "\t%lu bytes @ %p\n",
1359
             (unsigned long)next->size, (PNG_CONST void*)(next+1));
1360 1361 1362 1363 1364 1365 1366 1367 1368 1369 1370 1371 1372 1373 1374 1375 1376
         /* The NULL means this will always return, even if the memory is
          * corrupted.
          */
         store_memory_free(NULL, pool, next);
      }
      while (pool->list != NULL);
   }

   /* And reset the other fields too for the next time. */
   if (pool->max > pool->max_max) pool->max_max = pool->max;
   pool->max = 0;
   if (pool->current != 0) /* unexpected internal error */
      fprintf(stderr, "%s: %s %s: memory counter mismatch (internal error)\n",
         ps->test, pool == &ps->read_memory_pool ? "read" : "write",
         pool == &ps->read_memory_pool ? (ps->current != NULL ?
            ps->current->name : "unknown file") : ps->wname);
   pool->current = 0;
1377 1378 1379 1380

   if (pool->limit > pool->max_limit)
      pool->max_limit = pool->limit;

1381
   pool->limit = 0;
1382 1383 1384 1385

   if (pool->total > pool->max_total)
      pool->max_total = pool->total;

1386 1387 1388 1389 1390 1391 1392 1393
   pool->total = 0;

   /* Get a new mark too. */
   store_pool_mark(pool->mark);
}

/* The memory callbacks: */
static png_voidp
1394
store_malloc(png_structp ppIn, png_alloc_size_t cb)
1395
{
1396
   png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
1397 1398 1399
   store_pool *pool = voidcast(store_pool*, png_get_mem_ptr(pp));
   store_memory *new = voidcast(store_memory*, malloc(cb + (sizeof *new) +
      (sizeof pool->mark)));
1400 1401 1402

   if (new != NULL)
   {
1403 1404 1405
      if (cb > pool->max)
         pool->max = cb;

1406
      pool->current += cb;
1407 1408 1409 1410

      if (pool->current > pool->limit)
         pool->limit = pool->current;

1411 1412 1413 1414 1415 1416 1417 1418 1419 1420
      pool->total += cb;

      new->size = cb;
      memcpy(new->mark, pool->mark, sizeof new->mark);
      memcpy((png_byte*)(new+1) + cb, pool->mark, sizeof pool->mark);
      new->pool = pool;
      new->next = pool->list;
      pool->list = new;
      ++new;
   }
1421

1422
   else
1423 1424 1425 1426 1427 1428 1429 1430 1431 1432 1433 1434 1435 1436 1437
   {
      /* NOTE: the PNG user malloc function cannot use the png_ptr it is passed
       * other than to retrieve the allocation pointer!  libpng calls the
       * store_malloc callback in two basic cases:
       *
       * 1) From png_malloc; png_malloc will do a png_error itself if NULL is
       *    returned.
       * 2) From png_struct or png_info structure creation; png_malloc is
       *    to return so cleanup can be performed.
       *
       * To handle this store_malloc can log a message, but can't do anything
       * else.
       */
      store_log(pool->store, pp, "out of memory", 1 /* is_error */);
   }
1438 1439 1440 1441 1442

   return new;
}

static void
1443
store_free(png_structp ppIn, png_voidp memory)
1444
{
1445
   png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
1446 1447
   store_pool *pool = voidcast(store_pool*, png_get_mem_ptr(pp));
   store_memory *this = voidcast(store_memory*, memory), **test;
1448

1449 1450 1451 1452 1453 1454 1455 1456
   /* Because libpng calls store_free with a dummy png_struct when deleting
    * png_struct or png_info via png_destroy_struct_2 it is necessary to check
    * the passed in png_structp to ensure it is valid, and not pass it to
    * png_error if it is not.
    */
   if (pp != pool->store->pread && pp != pool->store->pwrite)
      pp = NULL;

1457
   /* First check that this 'memory' really is valid memory - it must be in the
1458
    * pool list.  If it is, use the shared memory_free function to free it.
1459 1460 1461 1462 1463 1464
    */
   --this;
   for (test = &pool->list; *test != this; test = &(*test)->next)
   {
      if (*test == NULL)
      {
1465
         store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "bad pointer to free");
1466 1467 1468 1469 1470 1471 1472 1473 1474
         return;
      }
   }

   /* Unlink this entry, *test == this. */
   *test = this->next;
   this->next = NULL;
   store_memory_free(pp, pool, this);
}
1475
#endif /* PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED */
1476

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1477 1478 1479
/* Setup functions. */
/* Cleanup when aborting a write or after storing the new file. */
static void
1480
store_write_reset(png_store *ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1481 1482 1483
{
   if (ps->pwrite != NULL)
   {
1484 1485 1486 1487 1488 1489 1490 1491 1492 1493
      anon_context(ps);

      Try
         png_destroy_write_struct(&ps->pwrite, &ps->piwrite);

      Catch_anonymous
      {
         /* memory corruption: continue. */
      }

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1494 1495 1496
      ps->pwrite = NULL;
      ps->piwrite = NULL;
   }
1497 1498 1499 1500

   /* And make sure that all the memory has been freed - this will output
    * spurious errors in the case of memory corruption above, but this is safe.
    */
1501 1502 1503
#  ifdef PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED
      store_pool_delete(ps, &ps->write_memory_pool);
#  endif
1504

1505
   store_freenew(ps);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1506 1507 1508
}

/* The following is the main write function, it returns a png_struct and,
1509
 * optionally, a png_info suitable for writiing a new PNG file.  Use
1510 1511
 * store_storefile above to record this file after it has been written.  The
 * returned libpng structures as destroyed by store_write_reset above.
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1512 1513
 */
static png_structp
1514 1515
set_store_for_write(png_store *ps, png_infopp ppi,
   PNG_CONST char * volatile name)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1516
{
1517
   anon_context(ps);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1518

1519 1520 1521
   Try
   {
      if (ps->pwrite != NULL)
1522
         png_error(ps->pwrite, "write store already in use");
1523 1524 1525

      store_write_reset(ps);
      safecat(ps->wname, sizeof ps->wname, 0, name);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1526

1527 1528 1529 1530 1531 1532 1533 1534 1535 1536 1537
      /* Don't do the slow memory checks if doing a speed test, also if user
       * memory is not supported we can't do it anyway.
       */
#     ifdef PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED
         if (!ps->speed)
            ps->pwrite = png_create_write_struct_2(PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING,
               ps, store_error, store_warning, &ps->write_memory_pool,
               store_malloc, store_free);

         else
#     endif
1538 1539
         ps->pwrite = png_create_write_struct(PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING,
            ps, store_error, store_warning);
1540

1541
      png_set_write_fn(ps->pwrite, ps, store_write, store_flush);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1542

1543 1544 1545 1546 1547 1548 1549 1550 1551 1552
#     ifdef PNG_SET_OPTION_SUPPORTED
         {
            int opt;
            for (opt=0; opt<ps->noptions; ++opt)
               if (png_set_option(ps->pwrite, ps->options[opt].option,
                  ps->options[opt].setting) == PNG_OPTION_INVALID)
                  png_error(ps->pwrite, "png option invalid");
         }
#     endif

1553 1554 1555 1556
      if (ppi != NULL)
         *ppi = ps->piwrite = png_create_info_struct(ps->pwrite);
   }

1557 1558
   Catch_anonymous
      return NULL;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1559

1560
   return ps->pwrite;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1561 1562
}

1563
/* Cleanup when finished reading (either due to error or in the success case).
1564 1565
 * This routine exists even when there is no read support to make the code
 * tidier (avoid a mass of ifdefs) and so easier to maintain.
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1566 1567
 */
static void
1568
store_read_reset(png_store *ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1569
{
1570 1571 1572 1573
#  ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
      if (ps->pread != NULL)
      {
         anon_context(ps);
1574

1575 1576
         Try
            png_destroy_read_struct(&ps->pread, &ps->piread, NULL);
1577

1578 1579 1580 1581
         Catch_anonymous
         {
            /* error already output: continue */
         }
1582

1583 1584 1585 1586
         ps->pread = NULL;
         ps->piread = NULL;
      }
#  endif
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1587

1588 1589 1590 1591
#  ifdef PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED
      /* Always do this to be safe. */
      store_pool_delete(ps, &ps->read_memory_pool);
#  endif
1592

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1593 1594 1595
   ps->current = NULL;
   ps->next = NULL;
   ps->readpos = 0;
1596
   ps->validated = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1597 1598
}

1599
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1600
static void
1601
store_read_set(png_store *ps, png_uint_32 id)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1602
{
1603
   png_store_file *pf = ps->saved;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1604 1605 1606 1607 1608 1609

   while (pf != NULL)
   {
      if (pf->id == id)
      {
         ps->current = pf;
1610
         ps->next = NULL;
1611
         store_read_buffer_next(ps);
1612
         return;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1613 1614 1615 1616 1617
      }

      pf = pf->next;
   }

1618
   {
1619 1620 1621 1622 1623 1624
      size_t pos;
      char msg[FILE_NAME_SIZE+64];

      pos = standard_name_from_id(msg, sizeof msg, 0, id);
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ": file not found");
      png_error(ps->pread, msg);
1625
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1626 1627 1628 1629 1630
}

/* The main interface for reading a saved file - pass the id number of the file
 * to retrieve.  Ids must be unique or the earlier file will be hidden.  The API
 * returns a png_struct and, optionally, a png_info.  Both of these will be
1631
 * destroyed by store_read_reset above.
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1632 1633
 */
static png_structp
1634
set_store_for_read(png_store *ps, png_infopp ppi, png_uint_32 id,
1635
   PNG_CONST char *name)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1636
{
1637
   /* Set the name for png_error */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1638 1639
   safecat(ps->test, sizeof ps->test, 0, name);

1640
   if (ps->pread != NULL)
1641
      png_error(ps->pread, "read store already in use");
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1642

1643
   store_read_reset(ps);
1644

1645
   /* Both the create APIs can return NULL if used in their default mode
1646 1647 1648 1649
    * (because there is no other way of handling an error because the jmp_buf
    * by default is stored in png_struct and that has not been allocated!)
    * However, given that store_error works correctly in these circumstances
    * we don't ever expect NULL in this program.
1650
    */
1651 1652 1653 1654 1655
#  ifdef PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED
      if (!ps->speed)
         ps->pread = png_create_read_struct_2(PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING, ps,
             store_error, store_warning, &ps->read_memory_pool, store_malloc,
             store_free);
1656

1657 1658 1659 1660
      else
#  endif
   ps->pread = png_create_read_struct(PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING, ps, store_error,
      store_warning);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1661

1662 1663 1664
   if (ps->pread == NULL)
   {
      struct exception_context *the_exception_context = &ps->exception_context;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1665

1666
      store_log(ps, NULL, "png_create_read_struct returned NULL (unexpected)",
1667
         1 /*error*/);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1668

1669
      Throw ps;
1670
   }
1671

1672 1673 1674 1675 1676 1677 1678 1679 1680 1681
#  ifdef PNG_SET_OPTION_SUPPORTED
      {
         int opt;
         for (opt=0; opt<ps->noptions; ++opt)
            if (png_set_option(ps->pread, ps->options[opt].option,
               ps->options[opt].setting) == PNG_OPTION_INVALID)
                  png_error(ps->pread, "png option invalid");
      }
#  endif

1682
   store_read_set(ps, id);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1683

1684 1685 1686 1687
   if (ppi != NULL)
      *ppi = ps->piread = png_create_info_struct(ps->pread);

   return ps->pread;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1688
}
1689
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1690

1691 1692 1693 1694 1695 1696 1697 1698 1699
/* The overall cleanup of a store simply calls the above then removes all the
 * saved files.  This does not delete the store itself.
 */
static void
store_delete(png_store *ps)
{
   store_write_reset(ps);
   store_read_reset(ps);
   store_freefile(&ps->saved);
1700
   store_image_free(ps, NULL);
1701 1702
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1703 1704
/*********************** PNG FILE MODIFICATION ON READ ************************/
/* Files may be modified on read.  The following structure contains a complete
1705
 * png_store together with extra members to handle modification and a special
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1706 1707 1708
 * read callback for libpng.  To use this the 'modifications' field must be set
 * to a list of png_modification structures that actually perform the
 * modification, otherwise a png_modifier is functionally equivalent to a
1709 1710
 * png_store.  There is a special read function, set_modifier_for_read, which
 * replaces set_store_for_read.
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1711
 */
1712 1713 1714 1715 1716 1717 1718
typedef enum modifier_state
{
   modifier_start,                        /* Initial value */
   modifier_signature,                    /* Have a signature */
   modifier_IHDR                          /* Have an IHDR */
} modifier_state;

1719 1720 1721 1722 1723 1724 1725 1726 1727 1728
typedef struct CIE_color
{
   /* A single CIE tristimulus value, representing the unique response of a
    * standard observer to a variety of light spectra.  The observer recognizes
    * all spectra that produce this response as the same color, therefore this
    * is effectively a description of a color.
    */
   double X, Y, Z;
} CIE_color;

1729 1730 1731 1732 1733 1734 1735 1736 1737 1738 1739 1740
typedef struct color_encoding
{
   /* A description of an (R,G,B) encoding of color (as defined above); this
    * includes the actual colors of the (R,G,B) triples (1,0,0), (0,1,0) and
    * (0,0,1) plus an encoding value that is used to encode the linear
    * components R, G and B to give the actual values R^gamma, G^gamma and
    * B^gamma that are stored.
    */
   double    gamma;            /* Encoding (file) gamma of space */
   CIE_color red, green, blue; /* End points */
} color_encoding;

1741 1742 1743 1744 1745 1746 1747 1748 1749 1750 1751 1752 1753
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
static double
chromaticity_x(CIE_color c)
{
   return c.X / (c.X + c.Y + c.Z);
}

static double
chromaticity_y(CIE_color c)
{
   return c.Y / (c.X + c.Y + c.Z);
}

1754 1755 1756 1757
static CIE_color
white_point(PNG_CONST color_encoding *encoding)
{
   CIE_color white;
1758

1759 1760 1761 1762 1763 1764 1765
   white.X = encoding->red.X + encoding->green.X + encoding->blue.X;
   white.Y = encoding->red.Y + encoding->green.Y + encoding->blue.Y;
   white.Z = encoding->red.Z + encoding->green.Z + encoding->blue.Z;

   return white;
}

1766
#ifdef PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED
1767 1768 1769 1770 1771 1772 1773 1774 1775 1776 1777 1778 1779 1780 1781 1782 1783 1784 1785
static void
normalize_color_encoding(color_encoding *encoding)
{
   PNG_CONST double whiteY = encoding->red.Y + encoding->green.Y +
      encoding->blue.Y;

   if (whiteY != 1)
   {
      encoding->red.X /= whiteY;
      encoding->red.Y /= whiteY;
      encoding->red.Z /= whiteY;
      encoding->green.X /= whiteY;
      encoding->green.Y /= whiteY;
      encoding->green.Z /= whiteY;
      encoding->blue.X /= whiteY;
      encoding->blue.Y /= whiteY;
      encoding->blue.Z /= whiteY;
   }
}
1786
#endif
1787 1788 1789 1790 1791 1792 1793 1794 1795 1796 1797 1798 1799 1800 1801 1802 1803 1804 1805 1806 1807 1808 1809 1810 1811 1812 1813 1814 1815 1816 1817 1818 1819 1820 1821 1822 1823 1824 1825 1826

static size_t
safecat_color_encoding(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos,
   PNG_CONST color_encoding *e, double encoding_gamma)
{
   if (e != 0)
   {
      if (encoding_gamma != 0)
         pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "(");
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "R(");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->red.X, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->red.Y, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->red.Z, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "),G(");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->green.X, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->green.Y, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->green.Z, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "),B(");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->blue.X, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->blue.Y, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->blue.Z, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ")");
      if (encoding_gamma != 0)
         pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ")");
   }

   if (encoding_gamma != 0)
   {
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "^");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, encoding_gamma, 5);
   }

   return pos;
}
1827
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
1828

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1829 1830
typedef struct png_modifier
{
1831
   png_store               this;             /* I am a png_store */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1832
   struct png_modification *modifications;   /* Changes to make */
1833

1834
   modifier_state           state;           /* My state */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1835 1836 1837 1838 1839 1840 1841 1842 1843 1844 1845 1846

   /* Information from IHDR: */
   png_byte                 bit_depth;       /* From IHDR */
   png_byte                 colour_type;     /* From IHDR */

   /* While handling PLTE, IDAT and IEND these chunks may be pended to allow
    * other chunks to be inserted.
    */
   png_uint_32              pending_len;
   png_uint_32              pending_chunk;

   /* Test values */
1847 1848 1849 1850 1851 1852 1853 1854 1855 1856 1857 1858 1859 1860 1861 1862
   double                   *gammas;
   unsigned int              ngammas;
   unsigned int              ngamma_tests;     /* Number of gamma tests to run*/
   double                    current_gamma;    /* 0 if not set */
   PNG_CONST color_encoding *encodings;
   unsigned int              nencodings;
   PNG_CONST color_encoding *current_encoding; /* If an encoding has been set */
   unsigned int              encoding_counter; /* For iteration */
   int                       encoding_ignored; /* Something overwrote it */

   /* Control variables used to iterate through possible encodings, the
    * following must be set to 0 and tested by the function that uses the
    * png_modifier because the modifier only sets it to 1 (true.)
    */
   unsigned int              repeat :1;   /* Repeat this transform test. */
   unsigned int              test_uses_encoding :1;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1863 1864

   /* Lowest sbit to test (libpng fails for sbit < 8) */
1865
   png_byte                 sbitlow;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1866 1867 1868 1869 1870

   /* Error control - these are the limits on errors accepted by the gamma tests
    * below.
    */
   double                   maxout8;  /* Maximum output value error */
G
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1871
   double                   maxabs8;  /* Absolute sample error 0..1 */
1872
   double                   maxcalc8; /* Absolute sample error 0..1 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1873 1874 1875
   double                   maxpc8;   /* Percentage sample error 0..100% */
   double                   maxout16; /* Maximum output value error */
   double                   maxabs16; /* Absolute sample error 0..1 */
1876
   double                   maxcalc16;/* Absolute sample error 0..1 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1877 1878
   double                   maxpc16;  /* Percentage sample error 0..100% */

1879 1880 1881 1882 1883 1884 1885
   /* This is set by transforms that need to allow a higher limit, it is an
    * internal check on pngvalid to ensure that the calculated error limits are
    * not ridiculous; without this it is too easy to make a mistake in pngvalid
    * that allows any value through.
    */
   double                   limit;    /* limit on error values, normally 4E-3 */

1886 1887 1888 1889 1890 1891
   /* Log limits - values above this are logged, but not necessarily
    * warned.
    */
   double                   log8;     /* Absolute error in 8 bits to log */
   double                   log16;    /* Absolute error in 16 bits to log */

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1892 1893 1894 1895 1896 1897 1898
   /* Logged 8 and 16 bit errors ('output' values): */
   double                   error_gray_2;
   double                   error_gray_4;
   double                   error_gray_8;
   double                   error_gray_16;
   double                   error_color_8;
   double                   error_color_16;
1899
   double                   error_indexed;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1900 1901

   /* Flags: */
1902 1903 1904 1905 1906
   /* Whether to call png_read_update_info, not png_read_start_image, and how
    * many times to call it.
    */
   int                      use_update_info;

1907 1908 1909
   /* Whether or not to interlace. */
   int                      interlace_type :9; /* int, but must store '1' */

1910 1911 1912
   /* Run the standard tests? */
   unsigned int             test_standard :1;

1913 1914 1915
   /* Run the odd-sized image and interlace read/write tests? */
   unsigned int             test_size :1;

1916 1917 1918
   /* Run tests on reading with a combiniation of transforms, */
   unsigned int             test_transform :1;

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1919
   /* When to use the use_input_precision option: */
1920 1921 1922
   unsigned int             use_input_precision :1;
   unsigned int             use_input_precision_sbit :1;
   unsigned int             use_input_precision_16to8 :1;
1923

1924 1925 1926 1927 1928 1929 1930 1931 1932
   /* If set assume that the calculation bit depth is set by the input
    * precision, not the output precision.
    */
   unsigned int             calculations_use_input_precision :1;

   /* If set assume that the calculations are done in 16 bits even if both input
    * and output are 8 bit or less.
    */
   unsigned int             assume_16_bit_calculations :1;
1933

1934
   /* Which gamma tests to run: */
1935 1936 1937
   unsigned int             test_gamma_threshold :1;
   unsigned int             test_gamma_transform :1; /* main tests */
   unsigned int             test_gamma_sbit :1;
1938
   unsigned int             test_gamma_scale16 :1;
1939 1940 1941
   unsigned int             test_gamma_background :1;
   unsigned int             test_gamma_alpha_mode :1;
   unsigned int             test_gamma_expand16 :1;
1942
   unsigned int             test_exhaustive :1;
1943

1944
   unsigned int             log :1;   /* Log max error */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1945 1946 1947 1948 1949 1950 1951 1952 1953 1954 1955

   /* Buffer information, the buffer size limits the size of the chunks that can
    * be modified - they must fit (including header and CRC) into the buffer!
    */
   size_t                   flush;           /* Count of bytes to flush */
   size_t                   buffer_count;    /* Bytes in buffer */
   size_t                   buffer_position; /* Position in buffer */
   png_byte                 buffer[1024];
} png_modifier;

/* This returns true if the test should be stopped now because it has already
1956 1957 1958
 * failed and it is running silently.
  */
static int fail(png_modifier *pm)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1959 1960
{
   return !pm->log && !pm->this.verbose && (pm->this.nerrors > 0 ||
1961
       (pm->this.treat_warnings_as_errors && pm->this.nwarnings > 0));
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1962 1963 1964 1965 1966 1967
}

static void
modifier_init(png_modifier *pm)
{
   memset(pm, 0, sizeof *pm);
1968
   store_init(&pm->this);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1969 1970
   pm->modifications = NULL;
   pm->state = modifier_start;
1971
   pm->sbitlow = 1U;
1972
   pm->ngammas = 0;
1973
   pm->ngamma_tests = 0;
1974
   pm->gammas = 0;
1975 1976 1977 1978 1979 1980 1981 1982
   pm->current_gamma = 0;
   pm->encodings = 0;
   pm->nencodings = 0;
   pm->current_encoding = 0;
   pm->encoding_counter = 0;
   pm->encoding_ignored = 0;
   pm->repeat = 0;
   pm->test_uses_encoding = 0;
1983 1984
   pm->maxout8 = pm->maxpc8 = pm->maxabs8 = pm->maxcalc8 = 0;
   pm->maxout16 = pm->maxpc16 = pm->maxabs16 = pm->maxcalc16 = 0;
1985
   pm->limit = 4E-3;
1986
   pm->log8 = pm->log16 = 0; /* Means 'off' */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1987 1988
   pm->error_gray_2 = pm->error_gray_4 = pm->error_gray_8 = 0;
   pm->error_gray_16 = pm->error_color_8 = pm->error_color_16 = 0;
1989
   pm->error_indexed = 0;
1990
   pm->use_update_info = 0;
1991
   pm->interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
1992
   pm->test_standard = 0;
1993
   pm->test_size = 0;
1994
   pm->test_transform = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1995 1996 1997
   pm->use_input_precision = 0;
   pm->use_input_precision_sbit = 0;
   pm->use_input_precision_16to8 = 0;
1998
   pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 0;
1999 2000 2001
   pm->test_gamma_threshold = 0;
   pm->test_gamma_transform = 0;
   pm->test_gamma_sbit = 0;
2002
   pm->test_gamma_scale16 = 0;
2003 2004 2005
   pm->test_gamma_background = 0;
   pm->test_gamma_alpha_mode = 0;
   pm->test_gamma_expand16 = 0;
2006
   pm->test_exhaustive = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2007 2008 2009 2010 2011
   pm->log = 0;

   /* Rely on the memset for all the other fields - there are no pointers */
}

2012
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
2013 2014 2015 2016 2017
/* If pm->calculations_use_input_precision is set then operations will happen
 * with only 8 bit precision unless both the input and output bit depth are 16.
 *
 * If pm->assume_16_bit_calculations is set then even 8 bit calculations use 16
 * bit precision.  This only affects those of the following limits that pertain
2018 2019
 * to a calculation - not a digitization operation - unless the following API is
 * called directly.
2020
 */
2021
#ifdef PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED
2022 2023 2024 2025 2026 2027 2028 2029 2030 2031 2032 2033 2034 2035 2036 2037 2038 2039 2040 2041 2042 2043 2044 2045
static double digitize(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, double value,
   int sample_depth, int do_round)
{
   /* 'value' is in the range 0 to 1, the result is the same value rounded to a
    * multiple of the digitization factor - 8 or 16 bits depending on both the
    * sample depth and the 'assume' setting.  Digitization is normally by
    * rounding and 'do_round' should be 1, if it is 0 the digitized value will
    * be truncated.
    */
   PNG_CONST unsigned int digitization_factor =
      (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations || sample_depth == 16) ? 65535 : 255;

   /* Limiting the range is done as a convenience to the caller - it's easier to
    * do it once here than every time at the call site.
    */
   if (value <= 0)
      value = 0;
   else if (value >= 1)
      value = 1;

   value *= digitization_factor;
   if (do_round) value += .5;
   return floor(value)/digitization_factor;
}
2046
#endif
2047

2048 2049
#if defined(PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED) ||\
   defined(PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED)
2050
static double abserr(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
2051
{
2052 2053 2054 2055 2056 2057 2058 2059
   /* Absolute error permitted in linear values - affected by the bit depth of
    * the calculations.
    */
   if (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations || (out_depth == 16 && (in_depth == 16 ||
      !pm->calculations_use_input_precision)))
      return pm->maxabs16;
   else
      return pm->maxabs8;
2060
}
2061
#endif
2062

2063
#ifdef PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED
2064
static double calcerr(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
2065
{
2066 2067
   /* Error in the linear composition arithmetic - only relevant when
    * composition actually happens (0 < alpha < 1).
2068
    */
2069 2070 2071
   if (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations || (out_depth == 16 && (in_depth == 16 ||
      !pm->calculations_use_input_precision)))
      return pm->maxcalc16;
2072
   else
2073
      return pm->maxcalc8;
2074 2075
}

2076
static double pcerr(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
2077
{
2078 2079 2080 2081 2082 2083 2084 2085
   /* Percentage error permitted in the linear values.  Note that the specified
    * value is a percentage but this routine returns a simple number.
    */
   if (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations || (out_depth == 16 && (in_depth == 16 ||
      !pm->calculations_use_input_precision)))
      return pm->maxpc16 * .01;
   else
      return pm->maxpc8 * .01;
2086 2087
}

2088 2089 2090 2091 2092 2093 2094 2095 2096 2097 2098
/* Output error - the error in the encoded value.  This is determined by the
 * digitization of the output so can be +/-0.5 in the actual output value.  In
 * the expand_16 case with the current code in libpng the expand happens after
 * all the calculations are done in 8 bit arithmetic, so even though the output
 * depth is 16 the output error is determined by the 8 bit calculation.
 *
 * This limit is not determined by the bit depth of internal calculations.
 *
 * The specified parameter does *not* include the base .5 digitization error but
 * it is added here.
 */
2099
static double outerr(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
2100 2101 2102
{
   /* There is a serious error in the 2 and 4 bit grayscale transform because
    * the gamma table value (8 bits) is simply shifted, not rounded, so the
2103
    * error in 4 bit grayscale gamma is up to the value below.  This is a hack
2104
    * to allow pngvalid to succeed:
2105 2106
    *
    * TODO: fix this in libpng
2107
    */
2108
   if (out_depth == 2)
2109 2110
      return .73182-.5;

2111
   if (out_depth == 4)
2112 2113
      return .90644-.5;

2114 2115 2116
   if (out_depth == 16 && (in_depth == 16 ||
      !pm->calculations_use_input_precision))
      return pm->maxout16;
2117

2118 2119 2120 2121 2122 2123 2124 2125 2126 2127
   /* This is the case where the value was calculated at 8-bit precision then
    * scaled to 16 bits.
    */
   else if (out_depth == 16)
      return pm->maxout8 * 257;

   else
      return pm->maxout8;
}

2128 2129 2130 2131
/* This does the same thing as the above however it returns the value to log,
 * rather than raising a warning.  This is useful for debugging to track down
 * exactly what set of parameters cause high error values.
 */
2132
static double outlog(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
2133 2134 2135 2136 2137 2138 2139 2140 2141 2142 2143 2144 2145 2146 2147 2148 2149 2150 2151 2152 2153 2154 2155 2156 2157 2158 2159 2160 2161 2162 2163 2164 2165
{
   /* The command line parameters are either 8 bit (0..255) or 16 bit (0..65535)
    * and so must be adjusted for low bit depth grayscale:
    */
   if (out_depth <= 8)
   {
      if (pm->log8 == 0) /* switched off */
         return 256;

      if (out_depth < 8)
         return pm->log8 / 255 * ((1<<out_depth)-1);

      return pm->log8;
   }

   if (out_depth == 16 && (in_depth == 16 ||
      !pm->calculations_use_input_precision))
   {
      if (pm->log16 == 0)
         return 65536;

      return pm->log16;
   }

   /* This is the case where the value was calculated at 8-bit precision then
    * scaled to 16 bits.
    */
   if (pm->log8 == 0)
      return 65536;

   return pm->log8 * 257;
}

2166 2167 2168 2169 2170
/* This complements the above by providing the appropriate quantization for the
 * final value.  Normally this would just be quantization to an integral value,
 * but in the 8 bit calculation case it's actually quantization to a multiple of
 * 257!
 */
2171
static int output_quantization_factor(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, int in_depth,
2172 2173 2174 2175 2176 2177 2178
   int out_depth)
{
   if (out_depth == 16 && in_depth != 16
      && pm->calculations_use_input_precision)
      return 257;
   else
      return 1;
2179
}
2180
#endif /* PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED */
2181

2182
/* One modification structure must be provided for each chunk to be modified (in
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2183 2184 2185 2186 2187 2188 2189 2190 2191 2192 2193 2194
 * fact more than one can be provided if multiple separate changes are desired
 * for a single chunk.)  Modifications include adding a new chunk when a
 * suitable chunk does not exist.
 *
 * The caller of modify_fn will reset the CRC of the chunk and record 'modified'
 * or 'added' as appropriate if the modify_fn returns 1 (true).  If the
 * modify_fn is NULL the chunk is simply removed.
 */
typedef struct png_modification
{
   struct png_modification *next;
   png_uint_32              chunk;
2195

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2196
   /* If the following is NULL all matching chunks will be removed: */
2197
   int                    (*modify_fn)(struct png_modifier *pm,
2198 2199
                               struct png_modification *me, int add);

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2200 2201 2202 2203 2204
   /* If the following is set to PLTE, IDAT or IEND and the chunk has not been
    * found and modified (and there is a modify_fn) the modify_fn will be called
    * to add the chunk before the relevant chunk.
    */
   png_uint_32              add;
2205 2206 2207
   unsigned int             modified :1;     /* Chunk was modified */
   unsigned int             added    :1;     /* Chunk was added */
   unsigned int             removed  :1;     /* Chunk was removed */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2208 2209
} png_modification;

2210 2211
static void
modification_reset(png_modification *pmm)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2212 2213 2214 2215 2216 2217 2218 2219 2220 2221 2222 2223 2224 2225 2226 2227 2228 2229 2230 2231 2232
{
   if (pmm != NULL)
   {
      pmm->modified = 0;
      pmm->added = 0;
      pmm->removed = 0;
      modification_reset(pmm->next);
   }
}

static void
modification_init(png_modification *pmm)
{
   memset(pmm, 0, sizeof *pmm);
   pmm->next = NULL;
   pmm->chunk = 0;
   pmm->modify_fn = NULL;
   pmm->add = 0;
   modification_reset(pmm);
}

2233
#ifdef PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED
2234 2235 2236 2237 2238 2239 2240 2241 2242 2243 2244
static void
modifier_current_encoding(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, color_encoding *ce)
{
   if (pm->current_encoding != 0)
      *ce = *pm->current_encoding;

   else
      memset(ce, 0, sizeof *ce);

   ce->gamma = pm->current_gamma;
}
2245
#endif
2246 2247 2248 2249 2250 2251 2252 2253 2254 2255 2256 2257 2258 2259 2260 2261 2262 2263 2264 2265 2266 2267 2268 2269 2270 2271 2272 2273 2274 2275 2276 2277 2278 2279 2280 2281 2282 2283 2284 2285 2286 2287 2288 2289 2290 2291 2292 2293 2294 2295 2296 2297 2298 2299 2300 2301 2302 2303 2304 2305 2306 2307 2308 2309 2310 2311 2312 2313 2314 2315 2316 2317 2318 2319 2320 2321 2322 2323 2324 2325

static size_t
safecat_current_encoding(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos,
   PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm)
{
   pos = safecat_color_encoding(buffer, bufsize, pos, pm->current_encoding,
      pm->current_gamma);

   if (pm->encoding_ignored)
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "[overridden]");

   return pos;
}

/* Iterate through the usefully testable color encodings.  An encoding is one
 * of:
 *
 * 1) Nothing (no color space, no gamma).
 * 2) Just a gamma value from the gamma array (including 1.0)
 * 3) A color space from the encodings array with the corresponding gamma.
 * 4) The same, but with gamma 1.0 (only really useful with 16 bit calculations)
 *
 * The iterator selects these in turn, the randomizer selects one at random,
 * which is used depends on the setting of the 'test_exhaustive' flag.  Notice
 * that this function changes the colour space encoding so it must only be
 * called on completion of the previous test.  This is what 'modifier_reset'
 * does, below.
 *
 * After the function has been called the 'repeat' flag will still be set; the
 * caller of modifier_reset must reset it at the start of each run of the test!
 */
static unsigned int
modifier_total_encodings(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm)
{
   return 1 +                 /* (1) nothing */
      pm->ngammas +           /* (2) gamma values to test */
      pm->nencodings +        /* (3) total number of encodings */
      /* The following test only works after the first time through the
       * png_modifier code because 'bit_depth' is set when the IHDR is read.
       * modifier_reset, below, preserves the setting until after it has called
       * the iterate function (also below.)
       *
       * For this reason do not rely on this function outside a call to
       * modifier_reset.
       */
      ((pm->bit_depth == 16 || pm->assume_16_bit_calculations) ?
         pm->nencodings : 0); /* (4) encodings with gamma == 1.0 */
}

static void
modifier_encoding_iterate(png_modifier *pm)
{
   if (!pm->repeat && /* Else something needs the current encoding again. */
      pm->test_uses_encoding) /* Some transform is encoding dependent */
   {
      if (pm->test_exhaustive)
      {
         if (++pm->encoding_counter >= modifier_total_encodings(pm))
            pm->encoding_counter = 0; /* This will stop the repeat */
      }

      else
      {
         /* Not exhaustive - choose an encoding at random; generate a number in
          * the range 1..(max-1), so the result is always non-zero:
          */
         if (pm->encoding_counter == 0)
            pm->encoding_counter = random_mod(modifier_total_encodings(pm)-1)+1;
         else
            pm->encoding_counter = 0;
      }

      if (pm->encoding_counter > 0)
         pm->repeat = 1;
   }

   else if (!pm->repeat)
      pm->encoding_counter = 0;
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2326 2327 2328
static void
modifier_reset(png_modifier *pm)
{
2329
   store_read_reset(&pm->this);
2330 2331 2332
   pm->limit = 4E-3;
   pm->pending_len = pm->pending_chunk = 0;
   pm->flush = pm->buffer_count = pm->buffer_position = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2333 2334
   pm->modifications = NULL;
   pm->state = modifier_start;
2335 2336 2337 2338 2339 2340 2341 2342 2343 2344
   modifier_encoding_iterate(pm);
   /* The following must be set in the next run.  In particular
    * test_uses_encodings must be set in the _ini function of each transform
    * that looks at the encodings.  (Not the 'add' function!)
    */
   pm->test_uses_encoding = 0;
   pm->current_gamma = 0;
   pm->current_encoding = 0;
   pm->encoding_ignored = 0;
   /* These only become value after IHDR is read: */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2345
   pm->bit_depth = pm->colour_type = 0;
2346 2347 2348 2349 2350 2351 2352 2353 2354 2355 2356 2357 2358 2359 2360 2361 2362 2363 2364 2365 2366 2367 2368 2369 2370 2371 2372 2373 2374 2375 2376 2377 2378 2379 2380 2381 2382 2383 2384 2385 2386 2387 2388 2389 2390 2391 2392 2393 2394 2395 2396 2397 2398 2399 2400 2401 2402 2403
}

/* The following must be called before anything else to get the encoding set up
 * on the modifier.  In particular it must be called before the transform init
 * functions are called.
 */
static void
modifier_set_encoding(png_modifier *pm)
{
   /* Set the encoding to the one specified by the current encoding counter,
    * first clear out all the settings - this corresponds to an encoding_counter
    * of 0.
    */
   pm->current_gamma = 0;
   pm->current_encoding = 0;
   pm->encoding_ignored = 0; /* not ignored yet - happens in _ini functions. */

   /* Now, if required, set the gamma and encoding fields. */
   if (pm->encoding_counter > 0)
   {
      /* The gammas[] array is an array of screen gammas, not encoding gammas,
       * so we need the inverse:
       */
      if (pm->encoding_counter <= pm->ngammas)
         pm->current_gamma = 1/pm->gammas[pm->encoding_counter-1];

      else
      {
         unsigned int i = pm->encoding_counter - pm->ngammas;

         if (i >= pm->nencodings)
         {
            i %= pm->nencodings;
            pm->current_gamma = 1; /* Linear, only in the 16 bit case */
         }

         else
            pm->current_gamma = pm->encodings[i].gamma;

         pm->current_encoding = pm->encodings + i;
      }
   }
}

/* Enquiry functions to find out what is set.  Notice that there is an implicit
 * assumption below that the first encoding in the list is the one for sRGB.
 */
static int
modifier_color_encoding_is_sRGB(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm)
{
   return pm->current_encoding != 0 && pm->current_encoding == pm->encodings &&
      pm->current_encoding->gamma == pm->current_gamma;
}

static int
modifier_color_encoding_is_set(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm)
{
   return pm->current_gamma != 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2404 2405 2406 2407 2408 2409 2410 2411 2412 2413 2414 2415 2416 2417 2418 2419 2420 2421 2422 2423 2424
}

/* Convenience macros. */
#define CHUNK(a,b,c,d) (((a)<<24)+((b)<<16)+((c)<<8)+(d))
#define CHUNK_IHDR CHUNK(73,72,68,82)
#define CHUNK_PLTE CHUNK(80,76,84,69)
#define CHUNK_IDAT CHUNK(73,68,65,84)
#define CHUNK_IEND CHUNK(73,69,78,68)
#define CHUNK_cHRM CHUNK(99,72,82,77)
#define CHUNK_gAMA CHUNK(103,65,77,65)
#define CHUNK_sBIT CHUNK(115,66,73,84)
#define CHUNK_sRGB CHUNK(115,82,71,66)

/* The guts of modification are performed during a read. */
static void
modifier_crc(png_bytep buffer)
{
   /* Recalculate the chunk CRC - a complete chunk must be in
    * the buffer, at the start.
    */
   uInt datalen = png_get_uint_32(buffer);
2425
   uLong crc = crc32(0, buffer+4, datalen+4);
2426 2427 2428
   /* The cast to png_uint_32 is safe because a crc32 is always a 32 bit value.
    */
   png_save_uint_32(buffer+datalen+8, (png_uint_32)crc);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2429 2430 2431 2432 2433 2434 2435 2436 2437 2438
}

static void
modifier_setbuffer(png_modifier *pm)
{
   modifier_crc(pm->buffer);
   pm->buffer_count = png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer)+12;
   pm->buffer_position = 0;
}

2439 2440 2441 2442
/* Separate the callback into the actual implementation (which is passed the
 * png_modifier explicitly) and the callback, which gets the modifier from the
 * png_struct.
 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2443
static void
2444
modifier_read_imp(png_modifier *pm, png_bytep pb, png_size_t st)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2445 2446 2447 2448 2449 2450 2451 2452 2453
{
   while (st > 0)
   {
      size_t cb;
      png_uint_32 len, chunk;
      png_modification *mod;

      if (pm->buffer_position >= pm->buffer_count) switch (pm->state)
      {
2454 2455
         static png_byte sign[8] = { 137, 80, 78, 71, 13, 10, 26, 10 };
         case modifier_start:
2456
            store_read_imp(&pm->this, pm->buffer, 8); /* size of signature. */
2457 2458
            pm->buffer_count = 8;
            pm->buffer_position = 0;
2459

2460
            if (memcmp(pm->buffer, sign, 8) != 0)
2461
               png_error(pm->this.pread, "invalid PNG file signature");
2462 2463
            pm->state = modifier_signature;
            break;
2464

2465
         case modifier_signature:
2466
            store_read_imp(&pm->this, pm->buffer, 13+12); /* size of IHDR */
2467 2468
            pm->buffer_count = 13+12;
            pm->buffer_position = 0;
2469

2470 2471
            if (png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer) != 13 ||
                png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer+4) != CHUNK_IHDR)
2472
               png_error(pm->this.pread, "invalid IHDR");
2473

2474
            /* Check the list of modifiers for modifications to the IHDR. */
2475 2476 2477
            mod = pm->modifications;
            while (mod != NULL)
            {
2478
               if (mod->chunk == CHUNK_IHDR && mod->modify_fn &&
2479
                   (*mod->modify_fn)(pm, mod, 0))
2480
                  {
2481 2482
                  mod->modified = 1;
                  modifier_setbuffer(pm);
2483
                  }
2484

2485
               /* Ignore removal or add if IHDR! */
2486 2487
               mod = mod->next;
            }
2488

2489 2490 2491
            /* Cache information from the IHDR (the modified one.) */
            pm->bit_depth = pm->buffer[8+8];
            pm->colour_type = pm->buffer[8+8+1];
2492

2493 2494 2495
            pm->state = modifier_IHDR;
            pm->flush = 0;
            break;
2496

2497 2498 2499 2500 2501
         case modifier_IHDR:
         default:
            /* Read a new chunk and process it until we see PLTE, IDAT or
             * IEND.  'flush' indicates that there is still some data to
             * output from the preceding chunk.
2502
             */
2503 2504 2505 2506
            if ((cb = pm->flush) > 0)
            {
               if (cb > st) cb = st;
               pm->flush -= cb;
2507
               store_read_imp(&pm->this, pb, cb);
2508 2509
               pb += cb;
               st -= cb;
2510
               if (st == 0) return;
2511
            }
2512

2513 2514 2515 2516
            /* No more bytes to flush, read a header, or handle a pending
             * chunk.
             */
            if (pm->pending_chunk != 0)
2517
            {
2518 2519 2520 2521 2522 2523
               png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer, pm->pending_len);
               png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+4, pm->pending_chunk);
               pm->pending_len = 0;
               pm->pending_chunk = 0;
            }
            else
2524
               store_read_imp(&pm->this, pm->buffer, 8);
2525

2526 2527
            pm->buffer_count = 8;
            pm->buffer_position = 0;
2528

2529 2530 2531
            /* Check for something to modify or a terminator chunk. */
            len = png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer);
            chunk = png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer+4);
2532

2533 2534 2535 2536 2537 2538 2539
            /* Terminators first, they may have to be delayed for added
             * chunks
             */
            if (chunk == CHUNK_PLTE || chunk == CHUNK_IDAT ||
                chunk == CHUNK_IEND)
            {
               mod = pm->modifications;
2540

2541
               while (mod != NULL)
2542
               {
2543 2544 2545
                  if ((mod->add == chunk ||
                      (mod->add == CHUNK_PLTE && chunk == CHUNK_IDAT)) &&
                      mod->modify_fn != NULL && !mod->modified && !mod->added)
2546
                  {
2547 2548 2549 2550
                     /* Regardless of what the modify function does do not run
                      * this again.
                      */
                     mod->added = 1;
2551

2552
                     if ((*mod->modify_fn)(pm, mod, 1 /*add*/))
2553 2554 2555 2556 2557 2558 2559 2560 2561 2562
                     {
                        /* Reset the CRC on a new chunk */
                        if (pm->buffer_count > 0)
                           modifier_setbuffer(pm);

                        else
                           {
                           pm->buffer_position = 0;
                           mod->removed = 1;
                           }
2563

2564 2565 2566 2567 2568 2569 2570
                        /* The buffer has been filled with something (we assume)
                         * so output this.  Pend the current chunk.
                         */
                        pm->pending_len = len;
                        pm->pending_chunk = chunk;
                        break; /* out of while */
                     }
2571
                  }
2572

2573 2574
                  mod = mod->next;
               }
2575

2576
               /* Don't do any further processing if the buffer was modified -
2577 2578
                * otherwise the code will end up modifying a chunk that was
                * just added.
2579 2580 2581 2582
                */
               if (mod != NULL)
                  break; /* out of switch */
            }
2583

2584 2585
            /* If we get to here then this chunk may need to be modified.  To
             * do this it must be less than 1024 bytes in total size, otherwise
2586 2587 2588 2589
             * it just gets flushed.
             */
            if (len+12 <= sizeof pm->buffer)
            {
2590
               store_read_imp(&pm->this, pm->buffer+pm->buffer_count,
2591 2592
                   len+12-pm->buffer_count);
               pm->buffer_count = len+12;
2593

2594 2595 2596 2597 2598
               /* Check for a modification, else leave it be. */
               mod = pm->modifications;
               while (mod != NULL)
               {
                  if (mod->chunk == chunk)
2599
                  {
2600 2601 2602 2603 2604 2605 2606 2607
                     if (mod->modify_fn == NULL)
                     {
                        /* Remove this chunk */
                        pm->buffer_count = pm->buffer_position = 0;
                        mod->removed = 1;
                        break; /* Terminate the while loop */
                     }

2608
                     else if ((*mod->modify_fn)(pm, mod, 0))
2609
                     {
2610 2611 2612 2613 2614 2615 2616 2617
                        mod->modified = 1;
                        /* The chunk may have been removed: */
                        if (pm->buffer_count == 0)
                        {
                           pm->buffer_position = 0;
                           break;
                        }
                        modifier_setbuffer(pm);
2618 2619
                     }
                  }
2620

2621
                  mod = mod->next;
2622 2623 2624
               }
            }

2625 2626
            else
               pm->flush = len+12 - pm->buffer_count; /* data + crc */
2627

2628 2629
            /* Take the data from the buffer (if there is any). */
            break;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2630 2631 2632
      }

      /* Here to read from the modifier buffer (not directly from
2633
       * the store, as in the flush case above.)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2634 2635
       */
      cb = pm->buffer_count - pm->buffer_position;
2636 2637 2638 2639

      if (cb > st)
         cb = st;

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2640 2641 2642 2643 2644 2645 2646
      memcpy(pb, pm->buffer + pm->buffer_position, cb);
      st -= cb;
      pb += cb;
      pm->buffer_position += cb;
   }
}

2647 2648
/* The callback: */
static void
2649
modifier_read(png_structp ppIn, png_bytep pb, png_size_t st)
2650
{
2651
   png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
2652
   png_modifier *pm = voidcast(png_modifier*, png_get_io_ptr(pp));
2653 2654 2655 2656 2657 2658 2659 2660 2661 2662 2663 2664 2665 2666 2667 2668 2669 2670

   if (pm == NULL || pm->this.pread != pp)
      png_error(pp, "bad modifier_read call");

   modifier_read_imp(pm, pb, st);
}

/* Like store_progressive_read but the data is getting changed as we go so we
 * need a local buffer.
 */
static void
modifier_progressive_read(png_modifier *pm, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   if (pm->this.pread != pp || pm->this.current == NULL ||
       pm->this.next == NULL)
      png_error(pp, "store state damaged (progressive)");

   /* This is another Horowitz and Hill random noise generator.  In this case
2671
    * the aim is to stress the progressive reader with truly horrible variable
2672 2673 2674
    * buffer sizes in the range 1..500, so a sequence of 9 bit random numbers
    * is generated.  We could probably just count from 1 to 32767 and get as
    * good a result.
2675 2676 2677 2678 2679 2680 2681 2682 2683 2684 2685 2686 2687 2688 2689 2690 2691 2692 2693 2694 2695 2696 2697 2698 2699 2700 2701 2702 2703 2704 2705 2706 2707 2708 2709 2710 2711 2712 2713 2714 2715 2716
    */
   for (;;)
   {
      static png_uint_32 noise = 1;
      png_size_t cb, cbAvail;
      png_byte buffer[512];

      /* Generate 15 more bits of stuff: */
      noise = (noise << 9) | ((noise ^ (noise >> (9-5))) & 0x1ff);
      cb = noise & 0x1ff;

      /* Check that this number of bytes are available (in the current buffer.)
       * (This doesn't quite work - the modifier might delete a chunk; unlikely
       * but possible, it doesn't happen at present because the modifier only
       * adds chunks to standard images.)
       */
      cbAvail = store_read_buffer_avail(&pm->this);
      if (pm->buffer_count > pm->buffer_position)
         cbAvail += pm->buffer_count - pm->buffer_position;

      if (cb > cbAvail)
      {
         /* Check for EOF: */
         if (cbAvail == 0)
            break;

         cb = cbAvail;
      }

      modifier_read_imp(pm, buffer, cb);
      png_process_data(pp, pi, buffer, cb);
   }

   /* Check the invariants at the end (if this fails it's a problem in this
    * file!)
    */
   if (pm->buffer_count > pm->buffer_position ||
       pm->this.next != &pm->this.current->data ||
       pm->this.readpos < pm->this.current->datacount)
      png_error(pp, "progressive read implementation error");
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2717 2718 2719
/* Set up a modifier. */
static png_structp
set_modifier_for_read(png_modifier *pm, png_infopp ppi, png_uint_32 id,
2720
    PNG_CONST char *name)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2721
{
2722 2723 2724 2725 2726 2727 2728
   /* Do this first so that the modifier fields are cleared even if an error
    * happens allocating the png_struct.  No allocation is done here so no
    * cleanup is required.
    */
   pm->state = modifier_start;
   pm->bit_depth = 0;
   pm->colour_type = 255;
2729

2730 2731 2732 2733 2734
   pm->pending_len = 0;
   pm->pending_chunk = 0;
   pm->flush = 0;
   pm->buffer_count = 0;
   pm->buffer_position = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2735

2736
   return set_store_for_read(&pm->this, ppi, id, name);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2737
}
2738 2739 2740 2741 2742 2743 2744 2745 2746 2747 2748 2749 2750 2751 2752 2753 2754 2755 2756 2757 2758 2759 2760 2761 2762 2763 2764 2765 2766 2767 2768 2769 2770 2771 2772 2773 2774 2775 2776 2777 2778 2779 2780 2781 2782 2783 2784 2785 2786 2787 2788 2789 2790 2791 2792 2793 2794 2795 2796 2797 2798 2799 2800 2801 2802 2803 2804 2805 2806 2807 2808 2809 2810 2811 2812 2813 2814 2815 2816 2817 2818 2819 2820 2821 2822 2823 2824 2825 2826 2827 2828 2829 2830 2831 2832 2833 2834 2835 2836 2837 2838 2839 2840 2841 2842 2843 2844 2845 2846 2847 2848 2849 2850 2851 2852 2853 2854 2855 2856 2857 2858 2859 2860 2861 2862 2863 2864 2865 2866 2867 2868 2869 2870


/******************************** MODIFICATIONS *******************************/
/* Standard modifications to add chunks.  These do not require the _SUPPORTED
 * macros because the chunks can be there regardless of whether this specific
 * libpng supports them.
 */
typedef struct gama_modification
{
   png_modification this;
   png_fixed_point  gamma;
} gama_modification;

static int
gama_modify(png_modifier *pm, png_modification *me, int add)
{
   UNUSED(add)
   /* This simply dumps the given gamma value into the buffer. */
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer, 4);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+4, CHUNK_gAMA);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+8, ((gama_modification*)me)->gamma);
   return 1;
}

static void
gama_modification_init(gama_modification *me, png_modifier *pm, double gammad)
{
   double g;

   modification_init(&me->this);
   me->this.chunk = CHUNK_gAMA;
   me->this.modify_fn = gama_modify;
   me->this.add = CHUNK_PLTE;
   g = fix(gammad);
   me->gamma = (png_fixed_point)g;
   me->this.next = pm->modifications;
   pm->modifications = &me->this;
}

typedef struct chrm_modification
{
   png_modification          this;
   PNG_CONST color_encoding *encoding;
   png_fixed_point           wx, wy, rx, ry, gx, gy, bx, by;
} chrm_modification;

static int
chrm_modify(png_modifier *pm, png_modification *me, int add)
{
   UNUSED(add)
   /* As with gAMA this just adds the required cHRM chunk to the buffer. */
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer   , 32);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+ 4, CHUNK_cHRM);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+ 8, ((chrm_modification*)me)->wx);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+12, ((chrm_modification*)me)->wy);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+16, ((chrm_modification*)me)->rx);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+20, ((chrm_modification*)me)->ry);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+24, ((chrm_modification*)me)->gx);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+28, ((chrm_modification*)me)->gy);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+32, ((chrm_modification*)me)->bx);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+36, ((chrm_modification*)me)->by);
   return 1;
}

static void
chrm_modification_init(chrm_modification *me, png_modifier *pm,
   PNG_CONST color_encoding *encoding)
{
   CIE_color white = white_point(encoding);

   /* Original end points: */
   me->encoding = encoding;

   /* Chromaticities (in fixed point): */
   me->wx = fix(chromaticity_x(white));
   me->wy = fix(chromaticity_y(white));

   me->rx = fix(chromaticity_x(encoding->red));
   me->ry = fix(chromaticity_y(encoding->red));
   me->gx = fix(chromaticity_x(encoding->green));
   me->gy = fix(chromaticity_y(encoding->green));
   me->bx = fix(chromaticity_x(encoding->blue));
   me->by = fix(chromaticity_y(encoding->blue));

   modification_init(&me->this);
   me->this.chunk = CHUNK_cHRM;
   me->this.modify_fn = chrm_modify;
   me->this.add = CHUNK_PLTE;
   me->this.next = pm->modifications;
   pm->modifications = &me->this;
}

typedef struct srgb_modification
{
   png_modification this;
   png_byte         intent;
} srgb_modification;

static int
srgb_modify(png_modifier *pm, png_modification *me, int add)
{
   UNUSED(add)
   /* As above, ignore add and just make a new chunk */
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer, 1);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+4, CHUNK_sRGB);
   pm->buffer[8] = ((srgb_modification*)me)->intent;
   return 1;
}

static void
srgb_modification_init(srgb_modification *me, png_modifier *pm, png_byte intent)
{
   modification_init(&me->this);
   me->this.chunk = CHUNK_sBIT;

   if (intent <= 3) /* if valid, else *delete* sRGB chunks */
   {
      me->this.modify_fn = srgb_modify;
      me->this.add = CHUNK_PLTE;
      me->intent = intent;
   }

   else
   {
      me->this.modify_fn = 0;
      me->this.add = 0;
      me->intent = 0;
   }

   me->this.next = pm->modifications;
   pm->modifications = &me->this;
}

2871
#ifdef PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED
2872 2873 2874 2875 2876 2877 2878 2879 2880 2881 2882 2883 2884 2885 2886 2887 2888 2889 2890 2891 2892 2893 2894 2895 2896 2897 2898 2899 2900 2901 2902 2903 2904 2905 2906 2907 2908 2909 2910 2911 2912 2913 2914 2915 2916 2917 2918 2919 2920 2921 2922 2923 2924 2925 2926 2927 2928 2929 2930 2931 2932 2933 2934 2935 2936 2937
typedef struct sbit_modification
{
   png_modification this;
   png_byte         sbit;
} sbit_modification;

static int
sbit_modify(png_modifier *pm, png_modification *me, int add)
{
   png_byte sbit = ((sbit_modification*)me)->sbit;
   if (pm->bit_depth > sbit)
   {
      int cb = 0;
      switch (pm->colour_type)
      {
         case 0:
            cb = 1;
            break;

         case 2:
         case 3:
            cb = 3;
            break;

         case 4:
            cb = 2;
            break;

         case 6:
            cb = 4;
            break;

         default:
            png_error(pm->this.pread,
               "unexpected colour type in sBIT modification");
      }

      png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer, cb);
      png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+4, CHUNK_sBIT);

      while (cb > 0)
         (pm->buffer+8)[--cb] = sbit;

      return 1;
   }
   else if (!add)
   {
      /* Remove the sBIT chunk */
      pm->buffer_count = pm->buffer_position = 0;
      return 1;
   }
   else
      return 0; /* do nothing */
}

static void
sbit_modification_init(sbit_modification *me, png_modifier *pm, png_byte sbit)
{
   modification_init(&me->this);
   me->this.chunk = CHUNK_sBIT;
   me->this.modify_fn = sbit_modify;
   me->this.add = CHUNK_PLTE;
   me->sbit = sbit;
   me->this.next = pm->modifications;
   pm->modifications = &me->this;
}
2938
#endif /* PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED */
2939
#endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2940 2941 2942

/***************************** STANDARD PNG FILES *****************************/
/* Standard files - write and save standard files. */
2943 2944 2945 2946 2947 2948 2949 2950 2951 2952 2953 2954
/* There are two basic forms of standard images.  Those which attempt to have
 * all the possible pixel values (not possible for 16bpp images, but a range of
 * values are produced) and those which have a range of image sizes.  The former
 * are used for testing transforms, in particular gamma correction and bit
 * reduction and increase.  The latter are reserved for testing the behavior of
 * libpng with respect to 'odd' image sizes - particularly small images where
 * rows become 1 byte and interlace passes disappear.
 *
 * The first, most useful, set are the 'transform' images, the second set of
 * small images are the 'size' images.
 *
 * The transform files are constructed with rows which fit into a 1024 byte row
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2955
 * buffer.  This makes allocation easier below.  Further regardless of the file
2956
 * format every row has 128 pixels (giving 1024 bytes for 64bpp formats).
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2957 2958
 *
 * Files are stored with no gAMA or sBIT chunks, with a PLTE only when needed
2959
 * and with an ID derived from the colour type, bit depth and interlace type
2960 2961 2962 2963 2964 2965 2966
 * as above (FILEID).  The width (128) and height (variable) are not stored in
 * the FILEID - instead the fields are set to 0, indicating a transform file.
 *
 * The size files ar constructed with rows a maximum of 128 bytes wide, allowing
 * a maximum width of 16 pixels (for the 64bpp case.)  They also have a maximum
 * height of 16 rows.  The width and height are stored in the FILEID and, being
 * non-zero, indicate a size file.
2967
 *
2968 2969 2970 2971 2972 2973
 * Because the PNG filter code is typically the largest CPU consumer within
 * libpng itself there is a tendency to attempt to optimize it.  This results in
 * special case code which needs to be validated.  To cause this to happen the
 * 'size' images are made to use each possible filter, in so far as this is
 * possible for smaller images.
 *
2974 2975 2976 2977 2978 2979 2980 2981 2982 2983 2984 2985 2986
 * For palette image (colour type 3) multiple transform images are stored with
 * the same bit depth to allow testing of more colour combinations -
 * particularly important for testing the gamma code because libpng uses a
 * different code path for palette images.  For size images a single palette is
 * used.
 */

/* Make a 'standard' palette.  Because there are only 256 entries in a palette
 * (maximum) this actually makes a random palette in the hope that enough tests
 * will catch enough errors.  (Note that the same palette isn't produced every
 * time for the same test - it depends on what previous tests have been run -
 * but a given set of arguments to pngvalid will always produce the same palette
 * at the same test!  This is why pseudo-random number generators are useful for
2987
 * testing.)
2988 2989 2990 2991 2992 2993 2994 2995 2996 2997 2998 2999 3000 3001 3002 3003 3004 3005
 *
 * The store must be open for write when this is called, otherwise an internal
 * error will occur.  This routine contains its own magic number seed, so the
 * palettes generated don't change if there are intervening errors (changing the
 * calls to the store_mark seed.)
 */
static store_palette_entry *
make_standard_palette(png_store* ps, int npalette, int do_tRNS)
{
   static png_uint_32 palette_seed[2] = { 0x87654321, 9 };

   int i = 0;
   png_byte values[256][4];

   /* Always put in black and white plus the six primary and secondary colors.
    */
   for (; i<8; ++i)
   {
3006 3007 3008
      values[i][1] = (png_byte)((i&1) ? 255U : 0U);
      values[i][2] = (png_byte)((i&2) ? 255U : 0U);
      values[i][3] = (png_byte)((i&4) ? 255U : 0U);
3009 3010
   }

3011
   /* Then add 62 grays (one quarter of the remaining 256 slots). */
3012 3013 3014 3015 3016 3017 3018 3019 3020 3021 3022 3023 3024 3025 3026 3027 3028 3029 3030 3031 3032 3033 3034 3035 3036 3037 3038 3039 3040 3041
   {
      int j = 0;
      png_byte random_bytes[4];
      png_byte need[256];

      need[0] = 0; /*got black*/
      memset(need+1, 1, (sizeof need)-2); /*need these*/
      need[255] = 0; /*but not white*/

      while (i<70)
      {
         png_byte b;

         if (j==0)
         {
            make_four_random_bytes(palette_seed, random_bytes);
            j = 4;
         }

         b = random_bytes[--j];
         if (need[b])
         {
            values[i][1] = b;
            values[i][2] = b;
            values[i++][3] = b;
         }
      }
   }

   /* Finally add 192 colors at random - don't worry about matches to things we
3042
    * already have, chance is less than 1/65536.  Don't worry about grays,
3043 3044 3045 3046 3047 3048 3049 3050 3051 3052 3053 3054 3055 3056 3057 3058 3059 3060 3061 3062 3063 3064 3065 3066 3067 3068 3069 3070 3071 3072 3073 3074 3075 3076 3077 3078 3079 3080 3081 3082 3083 3084 3085 3086 3087 3088 3089 3090
    * chance is the same, so we get a duplicate or extra gray less than 1 time
    * in 170.
    */
   for (; i<256; ++i)
      make_four_random_bytes(palette_seed, values[i]);

   /* Fill in the alpha values in the first byte.  Just use all possible values
    * (0..255) in an apparently random order:
    */
   {
      store_palette_entry *palette;
      png_byte selector[4];

      make_four_random_bytes(palette_seed, selector);

      if (do_tRNS)
         for (i=0; i<256; ++i)
            values[i][0] = (png_byte)(i ^ selector[0]);

      else
         for (i=0; i<256; ++i)
            values[i][0] = 255; /* no transparency/tRNS chunk */

      /* 'values' contains 256 ARGB values, but we only need 'npalette'.
       * 'npalette' will always be a power of 2: 2, 4, 16 or 256.  In the low
       * bit depth cases select colors at random, else it is difficult to have
       * a set of low bit depth palette test with any chance of a reasonable
       * range of colors.  Do this by randomly permuting values into the low
       * 'npalette' entries using an XOR mask generated here.  This also
       * permutes the npalette == 256 case in a potentially useful way (there is
       * no relationship between palette index and the color value therein!)
       */
      palette = store_write_palette(ps, npalette);

      for (i=0; i<npalette; ++i)
      {
         palette[i].alpha = values[i ^ selector[1]][0];
         palette[i].red   = values[i ^ selector[1]][1];
         palette[i].green = values[i ^ selector[1]][2];
         palette[i].blue  = values[i ^ selector[1]][3];
      }

      return palette;
   }
}

/* Initialize a standard palette on a write stream.  The 'do_tRNS' argument
 * indicates whether or not to also set the tRNS chunk.
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3091
 */
3092
/* TODO: the png_structp here can probably be 'const' in the future */
3093 3094 3095 3096 3097 3098 3099 3100 3101 3102 3103 3104 3105 3106 3107 3108 3109 3110 3111 3112 3113 3114 3115 3116 3117 3118 3119 3120 3121 3122 3123 3124 3125 3126 3127 3128 3129 3130 3131
static void
init_standard_palette(png_store *ps, png_structp pp, png_infop pi, int npalette,
   int do_tRNS)
{
   store_palette_entry *ppal = make_standard_palette(ps, npalette, do_tRNS);

   {
      int i;
      png_color palette[256];

      /* Set all entries to detect overread errors. */
      for (i=0; i<npalette; ++i)
      {
         palette[i].red = ppal[i].red;
         palette[i].green = ppal[i].green;
         palette[i].blue = ppal[i].blue;
      }

      /* Just in case fill in the rest with detectable values: */
      for (; i<256; ++i)
         palette[i].red = palette[i].green = palette[i].blue = 42;

      png_set_PLTE(pp, pi, palette, npalette);
   }

   if (do_tRNS)
   {
      int i, j;
      png_byte tRNS[256];

      /* Set all the entries, but skip trailing opaque entries */
      for (i=j=0; i<npalette; ++i)
         if ((tRNS[i] = ppal[i].alpha) < 255)
            j = i+1;

      /* Fill in the remainder with a detectable value: */
      for (; i<256; ++i)
         tRNS[i] = 24;

3132 3133 3134 3135
#     ifdef PNG_WRITE_tRNS_SUPPORTED
         if (j > 0)
            png_set_tRNS(pp, pi, tRNS, j, 0/*color*/);
#     endif
3136 3137
   }
}
3138

3139
/* The number of passes is related to the interlace type. There was no libpng
3140
 * API to determine this prior to 1.5, so we need an inquiry function:
3141 3142
 */
static int
3143
npasses_from_interlace_type(png_const_structp pp, int interlace_type)
3144 3145 3146 3147 3148 3149 3150 3151 3152 3153
{
   switch (interlace_type)
   {
   default:
      png_error(pp, "invalid interlace type");

   case PNG_INTERLACE_NONE:
      return 1;

   case PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7:
3154
      return PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7_PASSES;
3155 3156
   }
}
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3157

3158
static unsigned int
3159
bit_size(png_const_structp pp, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3160 3161 3162
{
   switch (colour_type)
   {
3163 3164
      default: png_error(pp, "invalid color type");

3165 3166 3167 3168 3169 3170 3171 3172 3173
      case 0:  return bit_depth;

      case 2:  return 3*bit_depth;

      case 3:  return bit_depth;

      case 4:  return 2*bit_depth;

      case 6:  return 4*bit_depth;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3174 3175 3176
   }
}

3177 3178 3179 3180
#define TRANSFORM_WIDTH  128U
#define TRANSFORM_ROWMAX (TRANSFORM_WIDTH*8U)
#define SIZE_ROWMAX (16*8U) /* 16 pixels, max 8 bytes each - 128 bytes */
#define STANDARD_ROWMAX TRANSFORM_ROWMAX /* The larger of the two */
3181
#define SIZE_HEIGHTMAX 16 /* Maximum range of size images */
3182

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3183
static size_t
3184 3185
transform_rowsize(png_const_structp pp, png_byte colour_type,
   png_byte bit_depth)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3186
{
3187
   return (TRANSFORM_WIDTH * bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth)) / 8;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3188 3189
}

3190
/* transform_width(pp, colour_type, bit_depth) current returns the same number
3191 3192
 * every time, so just use a macro:
 */
3193
#define transform_width(pp, colour_type, bit_depth) TRANSFORM_WIDTH
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3194 3195

static png_uint_32
3196
transform_height(png_const_structp pp, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3197 3198 3199
{
   switch (bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth))
   {
3200 3201 3202 3203 3204 3205 3206 3207 3208 3209 3210 3211 3212 3213 3214 3215 3216 3217
      case 1:
      case 2:
      case 4:
         return 1;   /* Total of 128 pixels */

      case 8:
         return 2;   /* Total of 256 pixels/bytes */

      case 16:
         return 512; /* Total of 65536 pixels */

      case 24:
      case 32:
         return 512; /* 65536 pixels */

      case 48:
      case 64:
         return 2048;/* 4 x 65536 pixels. */
3218
#        define TRANSFORM_HEIGHTMAX 2048
3219 3220 3221

      default:
         return 0;   /* Error, will be caught later */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3222 3223 3224
   }
}

3225
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
3226 3227 3228 3229
/* The following can only be defined here, now we have the definitions
 * of the transform image sizes.
 */
static png_uint_32
3230
standard_width(png_const_structp pp, png_uint_32 id)
3231 3232
{
   png_uint_32 width = WIDTH_FROM_ID(id);
3233
   UNUSED(pp)
3234 3235 3236 3237 3238 3239 3240 3241

   if (width == 0)
      width = transform_width(pp, COL_FROM_ID(id), DEPTH_FROM_ID(id));

   return width;
}

static png_uint_32
3242
standard_height(png_const_structp pp, png_uint_32 id)
3243 3244 3245 3246 3247 3248 3249 3250 3251 3252
{
   png_uint_32 height = HEIGHT_FROM_ID(id);

   if (height == 0)
      height = transform_height(pp, COL_FROM_ID(id), DEPTH_FROM_ID(id));

   return height;
}

static png_uint_32
3253
standard_rowsize(png_const_structp pp, png_uint_32 id)
3254 3255 3256 3257 3258 3259 3260
{
   png_uint_32 width = standard_width(pp, id);

   /* This won't overflow: */
   width *= bit_size(pp, COL_FROM_ID(id), DEPTH_FROM_ID(id));
   return (width + 7) / 8;
}
3261
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
3262

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3263
static void
3264
transform_row(png_const_structp pp, png_byte buffer[TRANSFORM_ROWMAX],
3265
   png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth, png_uint_32 y)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3266 3267 3268 3269 3270 3271
{
   png_uint_32 v = y << 7;
   png_uint_32 i = 0;

   switch (bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth))
   {
3272
      case 1:
3273
         while (i<128/8) buffer[i] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff), v += 17, ++i;
3274 3275 3276
         return;

      case 2:
3277
         while (i<128/4) buffer[i] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff), v += 33, ++i;
3278 3279 3280
         return;

      case 4:
3281
         while (i<128/2) buffer[i] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff), v += 65, ++i;
3282 3283 3284 3285
         return;

      case 8:
         /* 256 bytes total, 128 bytes in each row set as follows: */
3286
         while (i<128) buffer[i] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff), ++v, ++i;
3287 3288 3289
         return;

      case 16:
3290 3291
         /* Generate all 65536 pixel values in order, which includes the 8 bit
          * GA case as well as the 16 bit G case.
3292 3293
          */
         while (i<128)
3294 3295 3296 3297 3298 3299
         {
            buffer[2*i] = (png_byte)((v>>8) & 0xff);
            buffer[2*i+1] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff);
            ++v;
            ++i;
         }
3300 3301 3302 3303 3304 3305 3306 3307

         return;

      case 24:
         /* 65535 pixels, but rotate the values. */
         while (i<128)
         {
            /* Three bytes per pixel, r, g, b, make b by r^g */
3308 3309 3310
            buffer[3*i+0] = (png_byte)((v >> 8) & 0xff);
            buffer[3*i+1] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff);
            buffer[3*i+2] = (png_byte)(((v >> 8) ^ v) & 0xff);
3311 3312 3313 3314 3315 3316 3317 3318 3319 3320
            ++v;
            ++i;
         }

         return;

      case 32:
         /* 65535 pixels, r, g, b, a; just replicate */
         while (i<128)
         {
3321 3322 3323 3324
            buffer[4*i+0] = (png_byte)((v >> 8) & 0xff);
            buffer[4*i+1] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff);
            buffer[4*i+2] = (png_byte)((v >> 8) & 0xff);
            buffer[4*i+3] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff);
3325 3326 3327 3328 3329 3330 3331 3332 3333 3334 3335 3336 3337
            ++v;
            ++i;
         }

         return;

      case 48:
         /* y is maximum 2047, giving 4x65536 pixels, make 'r' increase by 1 at
          * each pixel, g increase by 257 (0x101) and 'b' by 0x1111:
          */
         while (i<128)
         {
            png_uint_32 t = v++;
3338 3339
            buffer[6*i+0] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
            buffer[6*i+1] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
3340
            t *= 257;
3341 3342
            buffer[6*i+2] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
            buffer[6*i+3] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
3343
            t *= 17;
3344 3345
            buffer[6*i+4] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
            buffer[6*i+5] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
3346 3347 3348 3349 3350 3351 3352 3353 3354 3355
            ++i;
         }

         return;

      case 64:
         /* As above in the 32 bit case. */
         while (i<128)
         {
            png_uint_32 t = v++;
3356 3357 3358 3359
            buffer[8*i+0] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
            buffer[8*i+1] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
            buffer[8*i+4] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
            buffer[8*i+5] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
3360
            t *= 257;
3361 3362 3363 3364
            buffer[8*i+2] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
            buffer[8*i+3] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
            buffer[8*i+6] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
            buffer[8*i+7] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
3365 3366 3367
            ++i;
         }
         return;
3368

3369 3370
      default:
         break;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3371 3372 3373 3374 3375
   }

   png_error(pp, "internal error");
}

3376 3377 3378 3379 3380
/* This is just to do the right cast - could be changed to a function to check
 * 'bd' but there isn't much point.
 */
#define DEPTH(bd) ((png_byte)(1U << (bd)))

3381 3382 3383 3384 3385 3386 3387
/* This is just a helper for compiling on minimal systems with no write
 * interlacing support.
 */
#ifndef PNG_WRITE_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
#  define png_set_interlace_handling(a) (1)
#endif

3388 3389 3390 3391 3392 3393
/* Make a standardized image given a an image colour type, bit depth and
 * interlace type.  The standard images have a very restricted range of
 * rows and heights and are used for testing transforms rather than image
 * layout details.  See make_size_images below for a way to make images
 * that test odd sizes along with the libpng interlace handling.
 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3394
static void
3395
make_transform_image(png_store* PNG_CONST ps, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type,
3396 3397
    png_byte PNG_CONST bit_depth, unsigned int palette_number,
    int interlace_type, png_const_charp name)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3398
{
3399
   context(ps, fault);
3400

3401
   Try
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3402 3403
   {
      png_infop pi;
3404 3405 3406 3407 3408 3409 3410 3411 3412 3413
      png_structp pp = set_store_for_write(ps, &pi, name);
      png_uint_32 h;

      /* In the event of a problem return control to the Catch statement below
       * to do the clean up - it is not possible to 'return' directly from a Try
       * block.
       */
      if (pp == NULL)
         Throw ps;

3414
      h = transform_height(pp, colour_type, bit_depth);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3415

3416
      png_set_IHDR(pp, pi, transform_width(pp, colour_type, bit_depth), h,
3417 3418 3419
         bit_depth, colour_type, interlace_type,
         PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE, PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE);

3420
#ifdef PNG_TEXT_SUPPORTED
3421 3422 3423 3424 3425
#  if defined(PNG_READ_zTXt_SUPPORTED) && defined(PNG_WRITE_zTXt_SUPPORTED)
#     define TEXT_COMPRESSION PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_zTXt
#  else
#     define TEXT_COMPRESSION PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_NONE
#  endif
3426 3427 3428 3429 3430 3431 3432 3433 3434
      {
         static char key[] = "image name"; /* must be writeable */
         size_t pos;
         png_text text;
         char copy[FILE_NAME_SIZE];

         /* Use a compressed text string to test the correct interaction of text
          * compression and IDAT compression.
          */
3435
         text.compression = TEXT_COMPRESSION;
3436 3437 3438 3439 3440 3441 3442 3443 3444 3445 3446 3447 3448
         text.key = key;
         /* Yuck: the text must be writable! */
         pos = safecat(copy, sizeof copy, 0, ps->wname);
         text.text = copy;
         text.text_length = pos;
         text.itxt_length = 0;
         text.lang = 0;
         text.lang_key = 0;

         png_set_text(pp, pi, &text, 1);
      }
#endif

3449
      if (colour_type == 3) /* palette */
3450
         init_standard_palette(ps, pp, pi, 1U << bit_depth, 1/*do tRNS*/);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3451

3452
      png_write_info(pp, pi);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3453

3454
      if (png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi) !=
3455
          transform_rowsize(pp, colour_type, bit_depth))
3456 3457 3458
         png_error(pp, "row size incorrect");

      else
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3459
      {
3460
         /* Somewhat confusingly this must be called *after* png_write_info
3461
          * because if it is called before, the information in *pp has not been
3462 3463 3464 3465
          * updated to reflect the interlaced image.
          */
         int npasses = png_set_interlace_handling(pp);
         int pass;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3466

3467 3468
         if (npasses != npasses_from_interlace_type(pp, interlace_type))
            png_error(pp, "write: png_set_interlace_handling failed");
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3469

3470
         for (pass=0; pass<npasses; ++pass)
3471
         {
3472
            png_uint_32 y;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3473

3474 3475
            for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
            {
3476
               png_byte buffer[TRANSFORM_ROWMAX];
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3477

3478
               transform_row(pp, buffer, colour_type, bit_depth, y);
3479 3480
               png_write_row(pp, buffer);
            }
3481
         }
3482
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3483

3484 3485 3486 3487 3488 3489 3490 3491 3492
#ifdef PNG_TEXT_SUPPORTED
      {
         static char key[] = "end marker";
         static char comment[] = "end";
         png_text text;

         /* Use a compressed text string to test the correct interaction of text
          * compression and IDAT compression.
          */
3493
         text.compression = TEXT_COMPRESSION;
3494 3495 3496 3497 3498 3499 3500 3501 3502 3503 3504
         text.key = key;
         text.text = comment;
         text.text_length = (sizeof comment)-1;
         text.itxt_length = 0;
         text.lang = 0;
         text.lang_key = 0;

         png_set_text(pp, pi, &text, 1);
      }
#endif

3505
      png_write_end(pp, pi);
3506

3507
      /* And store this under the appropriate id, then clean up. */
3508 3509
      store_storefile(ps, FILEID(colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
         interlace_type, 0, 0, 0));
3510

3511 3512
      store_write_reset(ps);
   }
3513

3514 3515
   Catch(fault)
   {
3516
      /* Use the png_store returned by the exception. This may help the compiler
3517 3518 3519 3520
       * because 'ps' is not used in this branch of the setjmp.  Note that fault
       * and ps will always be the same value.
       */
      store_write_reset(fault);
3521 3522
   }
}
3523

3524
static void
3525
make_transform_images(png_store *ps)
3526
{
3527 3528
   png_byte colour_type = 0;
   png_byte bit_depth = 0;
3529
   unsigned int palette_number = 0;
3530 3531 3532 3533 3534 3535 3536 3537

   /* This is in case of errors. */
   safecat(ps->test, sizeof ps->test, 0, "make standard images");

   /* Use next_format to enumerate all the combinations we test, including
    * generating multiple low bit depth palette images.
    */
   while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number))
3538 3539
   {
      int interlace_type;
3540

3541 3542 3543 3544 3545 3546
#     ifdef PNG_WRITE_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
         for (interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
              interlace_type < PNG_INTERLACE_LAST; ++interlace_type)
#     else
         interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
#     endif
3547
      {
3548 3549
         char name[FILE_NAME_SIZE];

3550 3551 3552 3553
         standard_name(name, sizeof name, 0, colour_type, bit_depth,
            palette_number, interlace_type, 0, 0, 0);
         make_transform_image(ps, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
            interlace_type, name);
3554
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3555 3556 3557
   }
}

3558 3559 3560 3561 3562 3563 3564 3565 3566 3567 3568 3569 3570 3571 3572 3573 3574 3575 3576 3577 3578 3579 3580
/* The following two routines use the PNG interlace support macros from
 * png.h to interlace or deinterlace rows.
 */
static void
interlace_row(png_bytep buffer, png_const_bytep imageRow,
   unsigned int pixel_size, png_uint_32 w, int pass)
{
   png_uint_32 xin, xout, xstep;

   /* Note that this can, trivially, be optimized to a memcpy on pass 7, the
    * code is presented this way to make it easier to understand.  In practice
    * consult the code in the libpng source to see other ways of doing this.
    */
   xin = PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass);
   xstep = 1U<<PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass);

   for (xout=0; xin<w; xin+=xstep)
   {
      pixel_copy(buffer, xout, imageRow, xin, pixel_size);
      ++xout;
   }
}

3581
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
3582 3583 3584 3585 3586 3587 3588 3589 3590 3591 3592 3593 3594 3595 3596 3597 3598 3599 3600 3601
static void
deinterlace_row(png_bytep buffer, png_const_bytep row,
   unsigned int pixel_size, png_uint_32 w, int pass)
{
   /* The inverse of the above, 'row' is part of row 'y' of the output image,
    * in 'buffer'.  The image is 'w' wide and this is pass 'pass', distribute
    * the pixels of row into buffer and return the number written (to allow
    * this to be checked).
    */
   png_uint_32 xin, xout, xstep;

   xout = PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass);
   xstep = 1U<<PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass);

   for (xin=0; xout<w; xout+=xstep)
   {
      pixel_copy(buffer, xout, row, xin, pixel_size);
      ++xin;
   }
}
3602
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
3603

3604
/* Build a single row for the 'size' test images; this fills in only the
3605 3606 3607 3608 3609 3610 3611 3612 3613 3614 3615 3616 3617 3618 3619 3620 3621 3622 3623 3624 3625 3626 3627 3628 3629 3630 3631 3632 3633 3634 3635 3636 3637 3638
 * first bit_width bits of the sample row.
 */
static void
size_row(png_byte buffer[SIZE_ROWMAX], png_uint_32 bit_width, png_uint_32 y)
{
   /* height is in the range 1 to 16, so: */
   y = ((y & 1) << 7) + ((y & 2) << 6) + ((y & 4) << 5) + ((y & 8) << 4);
   /* the following ensures bits are set in small images: */
   y ^= 0xA5;

   while (bit_width >= 8)
      *buffer++ = (png_byte)y++, bit_width -= 8;

   /* There may be up to 7 remaining bits, these go in the most significant
    * bits of the byte.
    */
   if (bit_width > 0)
   {
      png_uint_32 mask = (1U<<(8-bit_width))-1;
      *buffer = (png_byte)((*buffer & mask) | (y & ~mask));
   }
}

static void
make_size_image(png_store* PNG_CONST ps, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type,
    png_byte PNG_CONST bit_depth, int PNG_CONST interlace_type,
    png_uint_32 PNG_CONST w, png_uint_32 PNG_CONST h,
    int PNG_CONST do_interlace)
{
   context(ps, fault);

   Try
   {
      png_infop pi;
3639
      png_structp pp;
3640
      unsigned int pixel_size;
3641 3642 3643

      /* Make a name and get an appropriate id for the store: */
      char name[FILE_NAME_SIZE];
3644 3645
      PNG_CONST png_uint_32 id = FILEID(colour_type, bit_depth, 0/*palette*/,
         interlace_type, w, h, do_interlace);
3646 3647 3648

      standard_name_from_id(name, sizeof name, 0, id);
      pp = set_store_for_write(ps, &pi, name);
3649 3650 3651 3652 3653 3654 3655 3656 3657 3658 3659

      /* In the event of a problem return control to the Catch statement below
       * to do the clean up - it is not possible to 'return' directly from a Try
       * block.
       */
      if (pp == NULL)
         Throw ps;

      png_set_IHDR(pp, pi, w, h, bit_depth, colour_type, interlace_type,
         PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE, PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE);

3660 3661 3662 3663 3664 3665 3666 3667 3668 3669 3670 3671 3672 3673 3674 3675 3676 3677 3678 3679 3680 3681 3682 3683
#ifdef PNG_TEXT_SUPPORTED
      {
         static char key[] = "image name"; /* must be writeable */
         size_t pos;
         png_text text;
         char copy[FILE_NAME_SIZE];

         /* Use a compressed text string to test the correct interaction of text
          * compression and IDAT compression.
          */
         text.compression = TEXT_COMPRESSION;
         text.key = key;
         /* Yuck: the text must be writable! */
         pos = safecat(copy, sizeof copy, 0, ps->wname);
         text.text = copy;
         text.text_length = pos;
         text.itxt_length = 0;
         text.lang = 0;
         text.lang_key = 0;

         png_set_text(pp, pi, &text, 1);
      }
#endif

3684
      if (colour_type == 3) /* palette */
3685
         init_standard_palette(ps, pp, pi, 1U << bit_depth, 0/*do tRNS*/);
3686 3687 3688 3689 3690 3691 3692 3693 3694 3695 3696 3697 3698 3699 3700 3701

      png_write_info(pp, pi);

      /* Calculate the bit size, divide by 8 to get the byte size - this won't
       * overflow because we know the w values are all small enough even for
       * a system where 'unsigned int' is only 16 bits.
       */
      pixel_size = bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth);
      if (png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi) != ((w * pixel_size) + 7) / 8)
         png_error(pp, "row size incorrect");

      else
      {
         int npasses = npasses_from_interlace_type(pp, interlace_type);
         png_uint_32 y;
         int pass;
3702 3703 3704
#        ifdef PNG_WRITE_FILTER_SUPPORTED
            int nfilter = PNG_FILTER_VALUE_LAST;
#        endif
3705 3706 3707 3708 3709 3710 3711 3712 3713 3714 3715 3716 3717 3718 3719 3720 3721 3722 3723 3724 3725 3726 3727 3728 3729 3730 3731 3732 3733
         png_byte image[16][SIZE_ROWMAX];

         /* To help consistent error detection make the parts of this buffer
          * that aren't set below all '1':
          */
         memset(image, 0xff, sizeof image);

         if (!do_interlace && npasses != png_set_interlace_handling(pp))
            png_error(pp, "write: png_set_interlace_handling failed");

         /* Prepare the whole image first to avoid making it 7 times: */
         for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
            size_row(image[y], w * pixel_size, y);

         for (pass=0; pass<npasses; ++pass)
         {
            /* The following two are for checking the macros: */
            PNG_CONST png_uint_32 wPass = PNG_PASS_COLS(w, pass);

            /* If do_interlace is set we don't call png_write_row for every
             * row because some of them are empty.  In fact, for a 1x1 image,
             * most of them are empty!
             */
            for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
            {
               png_const_bytep row = image[y];
               png_byte tempRow[SIZE_ROWMAX];

               /* If do_interlace *and* the image is interlaced we
3734
                * need a reduced interlace row; this may be reduced
3735 3736 3737 3738 3739 3740 3741 3742 3743 3744 3745 3746 3747 3748 3749 3750 3751 3752 3753 3754 3755 3756 3757
                * to empty.
                */
               if (do_interlace && interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7)
               {
                  /* The row must not be written if it doesn't exist, notice
                   * that there are two conditions here, either the row isn't
                   * ever in the pass or the row would be but isn't wide
                   * enough to contribute any pixels.  In fact the wPass test
                   * can be used to skip the whole y loop in this case.
                   */
                  if (PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass) && wPass > 0)
                  {
                     /* Set to all 1's for error detection (libpng tends to
                      * set unset things to 0).
                      */
                     memset(tempRow, 0xff, sizeof tempRow);
                     interlace_row(tempRow, row, pixel_size, w, pass);
                     row = tempRow;
                  }
                  else
                     continue;
               }

3758
#           ifdef PNG_WRITE_FILTER_SUPPORTED
3759 3760 3761 3762 3763 3764 3765 3766 3767 3768 3769 3770 3771 3772 3773
               /* Only get to here if the row has some pixels in it, set the
                * filters to 'all' for the very first row and thereafter to a
                * single filter.  It isn't well documented, but png_set_filter
                * does accept a filter number (per the spec) as well as a bit
                * mask.
                *
                * The apparent wackiness of decrementing nfilter rather than
                * incrementing is so that Paeth gets used in all images bigger
                * than 1 row - it's the tricky one.
                */
               png_set_filter(pp, 0/*method*/,
                  nfilter >= PNG_FILTER_VALUE_LAST ? PNG_ALL_FILTERS : nfilter);

               if (nfilter-- == 0)
                  nfilter = PNG_FILTER_VALUE_LAST-1;
3774
#           endif
3775

3776 3777 3778 3779 3780
               png_write_row(pp, row);
            }
         }
      }

3781 3782 3783 3784 3785 3786 3787 3788 3789 3790 3791 3792 3793 3794 3795 3796 3797 3798 3799 3800 3801
#ifdef PNG_TEXT_SUPPORTED
      {
         static char key[] = "end marker";
         static char comment[] = "end";
         png_text text;

         /* Use a compressed text string to test the correct interaction of text
          * compression and IDAT compression.
          */
         text.compression = TEXT_COMPRESSION;
         text.key = key;
         text.text = comment;
         text.text_length = (sizeof comment)-1;
         text.itxt_length = 0;
         text.lang = 0;
         text.lang_key = 0;

         png_set_text(pp, pi, &text, 1);
      }
#endif

3802 3803 3804 3805 3806 3807 3808 3809 3810 3811 3812 3813 3814 3815 3816 3817 3818 3819 3820 3821 3822 3823 3824 3825 3826 3827 3828 3829 3830 3831 3832 3833 3834 3835 3836 3837 3838 3839 3840 3841
      png_write_end(pp, pi);

      /* And store this under the appropriate id, then clean up. */
      store_storefile(ps, id);

      store_write_reset(ps);
   }

   Catch(fault)
   {
      /* Use the png_store returned by the exception. This may help the compiler
       * because 'ps' is not used in this branch of the setjmp.  Note that fault
       * and ps will always be the same value.
       */
      store_write_reset(fault);
   }
}

static void
make_size(png_store* PNG_CONST ps, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type, int bdlo,
    int PNG_CONST bdhi)
{
   for (; bdlo <= bdhi; ++bdlo)
   {
      png_uint_32 width;

      for (width = 1; width <= 16; ++width)
      {
         png_uint_32 height;

         for (height = 1; height <= 16; ++height)
         {
            /* The four combinations of DIY interlace and interlace or not -
             * no interlace + DIY should be identical to no interlace with
             * libpng doing it.
             */
            make_size_image(ps, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), PNG_INTERLACE_NONE,
               width, height, 0);
            make_size_image(ps, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), PNG_INTERLACE_NONE,
               width, height, 1);
3842
#        ifdef PNG_WRITE_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
3843 3844
            make_size_image(ps, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7,
               width, height, 0);
3845
#        endif
3846 3847 3848 3849 3850 3851 3852 3853 3854 3855 3856 3857 3858 3859 3860 3861 3862 3863 3864 3865 3866 3867
            make_size_image(ps, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7,
               width, height, 1);
         }
      }
   }
}

static void
make_size_images(png_store *ps)
{
   /* This is in case of errors. */
   safecat(ps->test, sizeof ps->test, 0, "make size images");

   /* Arguments are colour_type, low bit depth, high bit depth
    */
   make_size(ps, 0, 0, WRITE_BDHI);
   make_size(ps, 2, 3, WRITE_BDHI);
   make_size(ps, 3, 0, 3 /*palette: max 8 bits*/);
   make_size(ps, 4, 3, WRITE_BDHI);
   make_size(ps, 6, 3, WRITE_BDHI);
}

3868
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
3869 3870
/* Return a row based on image id and 'y' for checking: */
static void
3871 3872
standard_row(png_const_structp pp, png_byte std[STANDARD_ROWMAX],
   png_uint_32 id, png_uint_32 y)
3873 3874 3875 3876 3877 3878 3879
{
   if (WIDTH_FROM_ID(id) == 0)
      transform_row(pp, std, COL_FROM_ID(id), DEPTH_FROM_ID(id), y);
   else
      size_row(std, WIDTH_FROM_ID(id) * bit_size(pp, COL_FROM_ID(id),
         DEPTH_FROM_ID(id)), y);
}
3880
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
3881

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3882
/* Tests - individual test cases */
3883 3884 3885 3886
/* Like 'make_standard' but errors are deliberately introduced into the calls
 * to ensure that they get detected - it should not be possible to write an
 * invalid image with libpng!
 */
3887 3888 3889
/* TODO: the 'set' functions can probably all be made to take a
 * png_const_structp rather than a modifiable one.
 */
3890
#ifdef PNG_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED
3891 3892 3893 3894 3895 3896 3897 3898 3899 3900 3901 3902 3903 3904 3905 3906 3907 3908 3909 3910 3911 3912 3913 3914 3915 3916 3917
static void
sBIT0_error_fn(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   /* 0 is invalid... */
   png_color_8 bad;
   bad.red = bad.green = bad.blue = bad.gray = bad.alpha = 0;
   png_set_sBIT(pp, pi, &bad);
}

static void
sBIT_error_fn(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_byte bit_depth;
   png_color_8 bad;

   if (png_get_color_type(pp, pi) == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
      bit_depth = 8;

   else
      bit_depth = png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi);

   /* Now we know the bit depth we can easily generate an invalid sBIT entry */
   bad.red = bad.green = bad.blue = bad.gray = bad.alpha =
      (png_byte)(bit_depth+1);
   png_set_sBIT(pp, pi, &bad);
}

3918
static PNG_CONST struct
3919 3920 3921 3922 3923 3924
{
   void          (*fn)(png_structp, png_infop);
   PNG_CONST char *msg;
   unsigned int    warning :1; /* the error is a warning... */
} error_test[] =
    {
3925
       /* no warnings makes these errors undetectable. */
3926 3927 3928 3929 3930
       { sBIT0_error_fn, "sBIT(0): failed to detect error", 1 },
       { sBIT_error_fn, "sBIT(too big): failed to detect error", 1 },
    };

static void
3931
make_error(png_store* volatile psIn, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type,
3932
    png_byte bit_depth, int interlace_type, int test, png_const_charp name)
3933
{
3934 3935
   png_store * volatile ps = psIn;

3936
   context(ps, fault);
3937

3938 3939 3940 3941
   Try
   {
      png_structp pp;
      png_infop pi;
3942

3943
      pp = set_store_for_write(ps, &pi, name);
3944

3945 3946
      if (pp == NULL)
         Throw ps;
3947

3948 3949
      png_set_IHDR(pp, pi, transform_width(pp, colour_type, bit_depth),
         transform_height(pp, colour_type, bit_depth), bit_depth, colour_type,
3950
         interlace_type, PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE, PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE);
3951

3952
      if (colour_type == 3) /* palette */
3953
         init_standard_palette(ps, pp, pi, 1U << bit_depth, 0/*do tRNS*/);
3954

3955
      /* Time for a few errors; these are in various optional chunks, the
3956 3957
       * standard tests test the standard chunks pretty well.
       */
3958 3959
#     define exception__prev exception_prev_1
#     define exception__env exception_env_1
3960 3961 3962 3963 3964 3965 3966
      Try
      {
         /* Expect this to throw: */
         ps->expect_error = !error_test[test].warning;
         ps->expect_warning = error_test[test].warning;
         ps->saw_warning = 0;
         error_test[test].fn(pp, pi);
3967

3968 3969
         /* Normally the error is only detected here: */
         png_write_info(pp, pi);
3970

3971 3972 3973
         /* And handle the case where it was only a warning: */
         if (ps->expect_warning && ps->saw_warning)
            Throw ps;
3974

3975 3976
         /* If we get here there is a problem, we have success - no error or
          * no warning - when we shouldn't have success.  Log an error.
3977
          */
3978
         store_log(ps, pp, error_test[test].msg, 1 /*error*/);
3979
      }
3980

3981
      Catch (fault)
3982
         ps = fault; /* expected exit, make sure ps is not clobbered */
3983 3984
#undef exception__prev
#undef exception__env
3985

3986 3987
      /* And clear these flags */
      ps->expect_error = 0;
3988
      ps->expect_warning = 0;
3989

3990 3991 3992 3993
      /* Now write the whole image, just to make sure that the detected, or
       * undetected, errro has not created problems inside libpng.
       */
      if (png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi) !=
3994
          transform_rowsize(pp, colour_type, bit_depth))
3995
         png_error(pp, "row size incorrect");
3996

3997 3998
      else
      {
3999
         png_uint_32 h = transform_height(pp, colour_type, bit_depth);
4000 4001 4002 4003 4004 4005
         int npasses = png_set_interlace_handling(pp);
         int pass;

         if (npasses != npasses_from_interlace_type(pp, interlace_type))
            png_error(pp, "write: png_set_interlace_handling failed");

4006
         for (pass=0; pass<npasses; ++pass)
4007 4008
         {
            png_uint_32 y;
4009

4010
            for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
4011
            {
4012
               png_byte buffer[TRANSFORM_ROWMAX];
4013

4014
               transform_row(pp, buffer, colour_type, bit_depth, y);
4015 4016
               png_write_row(pp, buffer);
            }
4017 4018
         }
      }
4019

4020
      png_write_end(pp, pi);
4021

4022 4023 4024
      /* The following deletes the file that was just written. */
      store_write_reset(ps);
   }
4025

4026 4027
   Catch(fault)
   {
4028
      store_write_reset(fault);
4029 4030 4031 4032 4033 4034 4035 4036 4037 4038 4039
   }
}

static int
make_errors(png_modifier* PNG_CONST pm, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type,
    int bdlo, int PNG_CONST bdhi)
{
   for (; bdlo <= bdhi; ++bdlo)
   {
      int interlace_type;

4040 4041 4042 4043 4044 4045
#     ifdef PNG_WRITE_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
         for (interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
              interlace_type < PNG_INTERLACE_LAST; ++interlace_type)
#     else
         interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
#     endif
4046 4047 4048 4049
      {
         unsigned int test;
         char name[FILE_NAME_SIZE];

4050 4051
         standard_name(name, sizeof name, 0, colour_type, 1<<bdlo, 0,
            interlace_type, 0, 0, 0);
4052 4053

         for (test=0; test<(sizeof error_test)/(sizeof error_test[0]); ++test)
4054
         {
4055 4056
            make_error(&pm->this, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), interlace_type,
               test, name);
4057

4058 4059
            if (fail(pm))
               return 0;
4060 4061
         }
      }
4062 4063 4064
   }

   return 1; /* keep going */
4065
}
4066
#endif /* PNG_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED */
4067 4068 4069 4070

static void
perform_error_test(png_modifier *pm)
{
4071
#ifdef PNG_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED /* else there are no cases that work! */
4072 4073 4074
   /* Need to do this here because we just write in this test. */
   safecat(pm->this.test, sizeof pm->this.test, 0, "error test");

4075
   if (!make_errors(pm, 0, 0, WRITE_BDHI))
4076 4077
      return;

4078
   if (!make_errors(pm, 2, 3, WRITE_BDHI))
4079 4080
      return;

4081
   if (!make_errors(pm, 3, 0, 3))
4082 4083
      return;

4084
   if (!make_errors(pm, 4, 3, WRITE_BDHI))
4085 4086
      return;

4087
   if (!make_errors(pm, 6, 3, WRITE_BDHI))
4088
      return;
4089 4090 4091 4092 4093 4094 4095 4096 4097 4098 4099 4100 4101 4102 4103 4104 4105 4106 4107 4108 4109
#else
   UNUSED(pm)
#endif
}

/* This is just to validate the internal PNG formatting code - if this fails
 * then the warning messages the library outputs will probably be garbage.
 */
static void
perform_formatting_test(png_store *volatile ps)
{
#ifdef PNG_TIME_RFC1123_SUPPORTED
   /* The handle into the formatting code is the RFC1123 support; this test does
    * nothing if that is compiled out.
    */
   context(ps, fault);

   Try
   {
      png_const_charp correct = "29 Aug 2079 13:53:60 +0000";
      png_const_charp result;
4110 4111 4112
#     if PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10600
         char timestring[29];
#     endif
4113 4114 4115 4116 4117 4118 4119 4120 4121 4122 4123 4124 4125 4126 4127 4128 4129
      png_structp pp;
      png_time pt;

      pp = set_store_for_write(ps, NULL, "libpng formatting test");

      if (pp == NULL)
         Throw ps;


      /* Arbitrary settings: */
      pt.year = 2079;
      pt.month = 8;
      pt.day = 29;
      pt.hour = 13;
      pt.minute = 53;
      pt.second = 60; /* a leap second */

4130 4131 4132 4133 4134 4135 4136 4137 4138
#     if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10600
         result = png_convert_to_rfc1123(pp, &pt);
#     else
         if (png_convert_to_rfc1123_buffer(timestring, &pt))
            result = timestring;

         else
            result = NULL;
#     endif
4139 4140 4141 4142 4143 4144 4145 4146 4147 4148 4149 4150 4151 4152 4153 4154 4155 4156 4157 4158 4159 4160 4161 4162 4163 4164 4165 4166

      if (result == NULL)
         png_error(pp, "png_convert_to_rfc1123 failed");

      if (strcmp(result, correct) != 0)
      {
         size_t pos = 0;
         char msg[128];

         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "png_convert_to_rfc1123(");
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, correct);
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ") returned: '");
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, result);
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "'");

         png_error(pp, msg);
      }

      store_write_reset(ps);
   }

   Catch(fault)
   {
      store_write_reset(fault);
   }
#else
   UNUSED(ps)
#endif
4167 4168
}

4169
#ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
4170 4171 4172 4173 4174 4175
/* Because we want to use the same code in both the progressive reader and the
 * sequential reader it is necessary to deal with the fact that the progressive
 * reader callbacks only have one parameter (png_get_progressive_ptr()), so this
 * must contain all the test parameters and all the local variables directly
 * accessible to the sequential reader implementation.
 *
4176
 * The technique adopted is to reinvent part of what Dijkstra termed a
4177 4178 4179 4180 4181 4182 4183 4184 4185 4186 4187 4188 4189 4190 4191
 * 'display'; an array of pointers to the stack frames of enclosing functions so
 * that a nested function definition can access the local (C auto) variables of
 * the functions that contain its definition.  In fact C provides the first
 * pointer (the local variables - the stack frame pointer) and the last (the
 * global variables - the BCPL global vector typically implemented as global
 * addresses), this code requires one more pointer to make the display - the
 * local variables (and function call parameters) of the function that actually
 * invokes either the progressive or sequential reader.
 *
 * Perhaps confusingly this technique is confounded with classes - the
 * 'standard_display' defined here is sub-classed as the 'gamma_display' below.
 * A gamma_display is a standard_display, taking advantage of the ANSI-C
 * requirement that the pointer to the first member of a structure must be the
 * same as the pointer to the structure.  This allows us to reuse standard_
 * functions in the gamma test code; something that could not be done with
4192
 * nested functions!
4193 4194 4195 4196 4197 4198
 */
typedef struct standard_display
{
   png_store*  ps;             /* Test parameters (passed to the function) */
   png_byte    colour_type;
   png_byte    bit_depth;
4199 4200 4201 4202
   png_byte    red_sBIT;       /* Input data sBIT values. */
   png_byte    green_sBIT;
   png_byte    blue_sBIT;
   png_byte    alpha_sBIT;
4203 4204 4205 4206 4207
   int         interlace_type;
   png_uint_32 id;             /* Calculated file ID */
   png_uint_32 w;              /* Width of image */
   png_uint_32 h;              /* Height of image */
   int         npasses;        /* Number of interlaced passes */
4208 4209 4210 4211
   png_uint_32 pixel_size;     /* Width of one pixel in bits */
   png_uint_32 bit_width;      /* Width of output row in bits */
   size_t      cbRow;          /* Bytes in a row of the output image */
   int         do_interlace;   /* Do interlacing internally */
4212 4213
   int         is_transparent; /* Transparency information was present. */
   int         speed;          /* Doing a speed test */
4214
   int         use_update_info;/* Call update_info, not start_image */
4215 4216 4217 4218 4219 4220
   struct
   {
      png_uint_16 red;
      png_uint_16 green;
      png_uint_16 blue;
   }           transparent;    /* The transparent color, if set. */
4221 4222
   int         npalette;       /* Number of entries in the palette. */
   store_palette
4223
               palette;
4224 4225
} standard_display;

4226
static void
4227
standard_display_init(standard_display *dp, png_store* ps, png_uint_32 id,
4228
   int do_interlace, int use_update_info)
4229
{
4230 4231
   memset(dp, 0, sizeof *dp);

4232
   dp->ps = ps;
4233 4234
   dp->colour_type = COL_FROM_ID(id);
   dp->bit_depth = DEPTH_FROM_ID(id);
4235 4236
   if (dp->bit_depth < 1 || dp->bit_depth > 16)
      internal_error(ps, "internal: bad bit depth");
4237 4238 4239 4240 4241
   if (dp->colour_type == 3)
      dp->red_sBIT = dp->blue_sBIT = dp->green_sBIT = dp->alpha_sBIT = 8;
   else
      dp->red_sBIT = dp->blue_sBIT = dp->green_sBIT = dp->alpha_sBIT =
         dp->bit_depth;
4242 4243 4244
   dp->interlace_type = INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id);
   dp->id = id;
   /* All the rest are filled in after the read_info: */
4245 4246 4247
   dp->w = 0;
   dp->h = 0;
   dp->npasses = 0;
4248 4249
   dp->pixel_size = 0;
   dp->bit_width = 0;
4250
   dp->cbRow = 0;
4251
   dp->do_interlace = do_interlace;
4252
   dp->is_transparent = 0;
4253
   dp->speed = ps->speed;
4254
   dp->use_update_info = use_update_info;
4255
   dp->npalette = 0;
4256 4257 4258 4259
   /* Preset the transparent color to black: */
   memset(&dp->transparent, 0, sizeof dp->transparent);
   /* Preset the palette to full intensity/opaque througout: */
   memset(dp->palette, 0xff, sizeof dp->palette);
4260 4261
}

4262 4263 4264 4265 4266 4267 4268 4269 4270 4271 4272 4273 4274 4275 4276 4277 4278 4279 4280 4281 4282 4283 4284 4285 4286 4287 4288 4289 4290 4291 4292 4293 4294 4295
/* Initialize the palette fields - this must be done later because the palette
 * comes from the particular png_store_file that is selected.
 */
static void
standard_palette_init(standard_display *dp)
{
   store_palette_entry *palette = store_current_palette(dp->ps, &dp->npalette);

   /* The remaining entries remain white/opaque. */
   if (dp->npalette > 0)
   {
      int i = dp->npalette;
      memcpy(dp->palette, palette, i * sizeof *palette);

      /* Check for a non-opaque palette entry: */
      while (--i >= 0)
         if (palette[i].alpha < 255)
            break;

#     ifdef __GNUC__
         /* GCC can't handle the more obviously optimizable version. */
         if (i >= 0)
            dp->is_transparent = 1;
         else
            dp->is_transparent = 0;
#     else
         dp->is_transparent = (i >= 0);
#     endif
   }
}

/* Utility to read the palette from the PNG file and convert it into
 * store_palette format.  This returns 1 if there is any transparency in the
 * palette (it does not check for a transparent colour in the non-palette case.)
4296 4297
 */
static int
4298 4299
read_palette(store_palette palette, int *npalette, png_const_structp pp,
   png_infop pi)
4300 4301 4302 4303 4304 4305
{
   png_colorp pal;
   png_bytep trans_alpha;
   int num;

   pal = 0;
4306 4307 4308
   *npalette = -1;

   if (png_get_PLTE(pp, pi, &pal, npalette) & PNG_INFO_PLTE)
4309
   {
4310
      int i = *npalette;
4311

4312 4313 4314 4315
      if (i <= 0 || i > 256)
         png_error(pp, "validate: invalid PLTE count");

      while (--i >= 0)
4316 4317 4318 4319 4320 4321
      {
         palette[i].red = pal[i].red;
         palette[i].green = pal[i].green;
         palette[i].blue = pal[i].blue;
      }

4322 4323 4324 4325
      /* Mark the remainder of the entries with a flag value (other than
       * white/opaque which is the flag value stored above.)
       */
      memset(palette + *npalette, 126, (256-*npalette) * sizeof *palette);
4326 4327 4328
   }

   else /* !png_get_PLTE */
4329 4330 4331 4332 4333
   {
      if (*npalette != (-1))
         png_error(pp, "validate: invalid PLTE result");
      /* But there is no palette, so record this: */
      *npalette = 0;
4334
      memset(palette, 113, sizeof (store_palette));
4335
   }
4336 4337

   trans_alpha = 0;
4338 4339 4340 4341
   num = 2; /* force error below */
   if ((png_get_tRNS(pp, pi, &trans_alpha, &num, 0) & PNG_INFO_tRNS) != 0 &&
      (trans_alpha != NULL || num != 1/*returns 1 for a transparent color*/) &&
      /* Oops, if a palette tRNS gets expanded png_read_update_info (at least so
4342 4343
       * far as 1.5.4) does not remove the trans_alpha pointer, only num_trans,
       * so in the above call we get a success, we get a pointer (who knows what
4344 4345 4346
       * to) and we get num_trans == 0:
       */
      !(trans_alpha != NULL && num == 0)) /* TODO: fix this in libpng. */
4347 4348 4349 4350 4351 4352 4353 4354 4355
   {
      int i;

      /* Any of these are crash-worthy - given the implementation of
       * png_get_tRNS up to 1.5 an app won't crash if it just checks the
       * result above and fails to check that the variables it passed have
       * actually been filled in!  Note that if the app were to pass the
       * last, png_color_16p, variable too it couldn't rely on this.
       */
4356
      if (trans_alpha == NULL || num <= 0 || num > 256 || num > *npalette)
4357 4358 4359 4360 4361
         png_error(pp, "validate: unexpected png_get_tRNS (palette) result");

      for (i=0; i<num; ++i)
         palette[i].alpha = trans_alpha[i];

4362
      for (num=*npalette; i<num; ++i)
4363 4364
         palette[i].alpha = 255;

4365 4366 4367
      for (; i<256; ++i)
         palette[i].alpha = 33; /* flag value */

4368 4369 4370 4371 4372
      return 1; /* transparency */
   }

   else
   {
4373
      /* No palette transparency - just set the alpha channel to opaque. */
4374 4375
      int i;

4376
      for (i=0, num=*npalette; i<num; ++i)
4377 4378
         palette[i].alpha = 255;

4379 4380 4381
      for (; i<256; ++i)
         palette[i].alpha = 55; /* flag value */

4382 4383 4384 4385
      return 0; /* no transparency */
   }
}

4386 4387 4388 4389
/* Utility to validate the palette if it should not have changed (the
 * non-transform case).
 */
static void
4390 4391
standard_palette_validate(standard_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
   png_infop pi)
4392 4393 4394 4395 4396 4397 4398 4399 4400 4401 4402 4403 4404 4405 4406 4407 4408 4409 4410 4411 4412 4413 4414 4415 4416 4417 4418 4419 4420 4421 4422
{
   int npalette;
   store_palette palette;

   if (read_palette(palette, &npalette, pp, pi) != dp->is_transparent)
      png_error(pp, "validate: palette transparency changed");

   if (npalette != dp->npalette)
   {
      size_t pos = 0;
      char msg[64];

      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "validate: palette size changed: ");
      pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, dp->npalette);
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " -> ");
      pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, npalette);
      png_error(pp, msg);
   }

   {
      int i = npalette; /* npalette is aliased */

      while (--i >= 0)
         if (palette[i].red != dp->palette[i].red ||
            palette[i].green != dp->palette[i].green ||
            palette[i].blue != dp->palette[i].blue ||
            palette[i].alpha != dp->palette[i].alpha)
            png_error(pp, "validate: PLTE or tRNS chunk changed");
   }
}

4423
/* By passing a 'standard_display' the progressive callbacks can be used
4424
 * directly by the sequential code, the functions suffixed "_imp" are the
4425 4426 4427 4428 4429 4430 4431 4432
 * implementations, the functions without the suffix are the callbacks.
 *
 * The code for the info callback is split into two because this callback calls
 * png_read_update_info or png_start_read_image and what gets called depends on
 * whether the info needs updating (we want to test both calls in pngvalid.)
 */
static void
standard_info_part1(standard_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
4433
{
4434
   if (png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi) != dp->bit_depth)
4435 4436
      png_error(pp, "validate: bit depth changed");

4437
   if (png_get_color_type(pp, pi) != dp->colour_type)
4438 4439 4440 4441 4442
      png_error(pp, "validate: color type changed");

   if (png_get_filter_type(pp, pi) != PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE)
      png_error(pp, "validate: filter type changed");

4443
   if (png_get_interlace_type(pp, pi) != dp->interlace_type)
4444 4445 4446 4447 4448
      png_error(pp, "validate: interlacing changed");

   if (png_get_compression_type(pp, pi) != PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE)
      png_error(pp, "validate: compression type changed");

4449 4450
   dp->w = png_get_image_width(pp, pi);

4451
   if (dp->w != standard_width(pp, dp->id))
4452 4453 4454 4455
      png_error(pp, "validate: image width changed");

   dp->h = png_get_image_height(pp, pi);

4456
   if (dp->h != standard_height(pp, dp->id))
4457 4458
      png_error(pp, "validate: image height changed");

4459 4460 4461 4462 4463 4464 4465 4466 4467 4468 4469 4470 4471 4472 4473 4474 4475 4476 4477 4478 4479 4480 4481 4482 4483 4484 4485 4486 4487 4488 4489 4490 4491 4492 4493 4494 4495 4496 4497 4498 4499 4500 4501 4502 4503 4504 4505 4506 4507 4508 4509 4510 4511 4512 4513
   /* Record (but don't check at present) the input sBIT according to the colour
    * type information.
    */
   {
      png_color_8p sBIT = 0;

      if (png_get_sBIT(pp, pi, &sBIT) & PNG_INFO_sBIT)
      {
         int sBIT_invalid = 0;

         if (sBIT == 0)
            png_error(pp, "validate: unexpected png_get_sBIT result");

         if (dp->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR)
         {
            if (sBIT->red == 0 || sBIT->red > dp->bit_depth)
               sBIT_invalid = 1;
            else
               dp->red_sBIT = sBIT->red;

            if (sBIT->green == 0 || sBIT->green > dp->bit_depth)
               sBIT_invalid = 1;
            else
               dp->green_sBIT = sBIT->green;

            if (sBIT->blue == 0 || sBIT->blue > dp->bit_depth)
               sBIT_invalid = 1;
            else
               dp->blue_sBIT = sBIT->blue;
         }

         else /* !COLOR */
         {
            if (sBIT->gray == 0 || sBIT->gray > dp->bit_depth)
               sBIT_invalid = 1;
            else
               dp->blue_sBIT = dp->green_sBIT = dp->red_sBIT = sBIT->gray;
         }

         /* All 8 bits in tRNS for a palette image are significant - see the
          * spec.
          */
         if (dp->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA)
         {
            if (sBIT->alpha == 0 || sBIT->alpha > dp->bit_depth)
               sBIT_invalid = 1;
            else
               dp->alpha_sBIT = sBIT->alpha;
         }

         if (sBIT_invalid)
            png_error(pp, "validate: sBIT value out of range");
      }
   }

4514 4515
   /* Important: this is validating the value *before* any transforms have been
    * put in place.  It doesn't matter for the standard tests, where there are
4516
    * no transforms, but it does for other tests where rowbytes may change after
4517 4518
    * png_read_update_info.
    */
4519
   if (png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi) != standard_rowsize(pp, dp->id))
4520 4521
      png_error(pp, "validate: row size changed");

4522 4523
   /* Validate the colour type 3 palette (this can be present on other color
    * types.)
4524
    */
4525
   standard_palette_validate(dp, pp, pi);
4526

4527 4528 4529 4530
   /* In any case always check for a tranparent color (notice that the
    * colour type 3 case must not give a successful return on the get_tRNS call
    * with these arguments!)
    */
4531 4532 4533 4534 4535 4536 4537 4538 4539 4540 4541 4542 4543 4544 4545 4546 4547 4548 4549 4550 4551 4552 4553 4554 4555 4556 4557 4558 4559 4560 4561 4562 4563 4564
   {
      png_color_16p trans_color = 0;

      if (png_get_tRNS(pp, pi, 0, 0, &trans_color) & PNG_INFO_tRNS)
      {
         if (trans_color == 0)
            png_error(pp, "validate: unexpected png_get_tRNS (color) result");

         switch (dp->colour_type)
         {
         case 0:
            dp->transparent.red = dp->transparent.green = dp->transparent.blue =
               trans_color->gray;
            dp->is_transparent = 1;
            break;

         case 2:
            dp->transparent.red = trans_color->red;
            dp->transparent.green = trans_color->green;
            dp->transparent.blue = trans_color->blue;
            dp->is_transparent = 1;
            break;

         case 3:
            /* Not expected because it should result in the array case
             * above.
             */
            png_error(pp, "validate: unexpected png_get_tRNS result");
            break;

         default:
            png_error(pp, "validate: invalid tRNS chunk with alpha image");
         }
      }
4565 4566 4567 4568
   }

   /* Read the number of passes - expected to match the value used when
    * creating the image (interlaced or not).  This has the side effect of
4569
    * turning on interlace handling (if do_interlace is not set.)
4570
    */
4571 4572
   dp->npasses = npasses_from_interlace_type(pp, dp->interlace_type);
   if (!dp->do_interlace && dp->npasses != png_set_interlace_handling(pp))
4573 4574
      png_error(pp, "validate: file changed interlace type");

4575 4576 4577
   /* Caller calls png_read_update_info or png_start_read_image now, then calls
    * part2.
    */
4578 4579
}

4580 4581 4582 4583
/* This must be called *after* the png_read_update_info call to get the correct
 * 'rowbytes' value, otherwise png_get_rowbytes will refer to the untransformed
 * image.
 */
4584
static void
4585 4586
standard_info_part2(standard_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
    png_const_infop pi, int nImages)
4587
{
4588
   /* Record cbRow now that it can be found. */
4589 4590 4591
   dp->pixel_size = bit_size(pp, png_get_color_type(pp, pi),
      png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi));
   dp->bit_width = png_get_image_width(pp, pi) * dp->pixel_size;
4592
   dp->cbRow = png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi);
4593

4594 4595 4596 4597
   /* Validate the rowbytes here again. */
   if (dp->cbRow != (dp->bit_width+7)/8)
      png_error(pp, "bad png_get_rowbytes calculation");

4598
   /* Then ensure there is enough space for the output image(s). */
4599
   store_ensure_image(dp->ps, pp, nImages, dp->cbRow, dp->h);
4600 4601 4602
}

static void
4603 4604
standard_info_imp(standard_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi,
    int nImages)
4605 4606 4607 4608
{
   /* Note that the validation routine has the side effect of turning on
    * interlace handling in the subsequent code.
    */
4609
   standard_info_part1(dp, pp, pi);
4610 4611 4612 4613

   /* And the info callback has to call this (or png_read_update_info - see
    * below in the png_modifier code for that variant.
    */
4614 4615 4616 4617 4618 4619 4620 4621 4622 4623
   if (dp->use_update_info)
   {
      /* For debugging the effect of multiple calls: */
      int i = dp->use_update_info;
      while (i-- > 0)
         png_read_update_info(pp, pi);
   }

   else
      png_start_read_image(pp);
4624 4625 4626 4627

   /* Validate the height, width and rowbytes plus ensure that sufficient buffer
    * exists for decoding the image.
    */
4628 4629 4630 4631 4632 4633
   standard_info_part2(dp, pp, pi, nImages);
}

static void
standard_info(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
4634 4635
   standard_display *dp = voidcast(standard_display*,
      png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
4636 4637 4638 4639

   /* Call with nImages==1 because the progressive reader can only produce one
    * image.
    */
4640
   standard_info_imp(dp, pp, pi, 1 /*only one image*/);
4641 4642 4643
}

static void
4644
progressive_row(png_structp ppIn, png_bytep new_row, png_uint_32 y, int pass)
4645
{
4646
   png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
4647 4648
   PNG_CONST standard_display *dp = voidcast(standard_display*,
      png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
4649 4650

   /* When handling interlacing some rows will be absent in each pass, the
4651 4652 4653
    * callback still gets called, but with a NULL pointer.  This is checked
    * in the 'else' clause below.  We need our own 'cbRow', but we can't call
    * png_get_rowbytes because we got no info structure.
4654 4655 4656
    */
   if (new_row != NULL)
   {
4657 4658 4659 4660 4661 4662
      png_bytep row;

      /* In the case where the reader doesn't do the interlace it gives
       * us the y in the sub-image:
       */
      if (dp->do_interlace && dp->interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7)
4663
      {
4664
#ifdef PNG_USER_TRANSFORM_INFO_SUPPORTED
4665 4666 4667 4668
         /* Use this opportunity to validate the png 'current' APIs: */
         if (y != png_get_current_row_number(pp))
            png_error(pp, "png_get_current_row_number is broken");

4669 4670
         if (pass != png_get_current_pass_number(pp))
            png_error(pp, "png_get_current_pass_number is broken");
4671
#endif
4672

4673
         y = PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(y, pass);
4674
      }
4675 4676 4677 4678 4679

      /* Validate this just in case. */
      if (y >= dp->h)
         png_error(pp, "invalid y to progressive row callback");

4680
      row = store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, 0, y);
4681

4682
#ifdef PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
4683
      /* Combine the new row into the old: */
4684 4685 4686 4687 4688
      if (dp->do_interlace)
      {
         if (dp->interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7)
            deinterlace_row(row, new_row, dp->pixel_size, dp->w, pass);
         else
4689
            row_copy(row, new_row, dp->pixel_size * dp->w);
4690 4691 4692
      }
      else
         png_progressive_combine_row(pp, row, new_row);
4693 4694 4695 4696 4697 4698 4699
#endif /* PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED */
   }

#ifdef PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
   else if (dp->interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7 &&
       PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass) &&
       PNG_PASS_COLS(dp->w, pass) > 0)
4700
      png_error(pp, "missing row in progressive de-interlacing");
4701
#endif /* PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED */
4702 4703
}

4704 4705
static void
sequential_row(standard_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi,
4706
    PNG_CONST int iImage, PNG_CONST int iDisplay)
4707 4708
{
   PNG_CONST int         npasses = dp->npasses;
4709 4710 4711 4712
   PNG_CONST int         do_interlace = dp->do_interlace &&
      dp->interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7;
   PNG_CONST png_uint_32 height = standard_height(pp, dp->id);
   PNG_CONST png_uint_32 width = standard_width(pp, dp->id);
4713
   PNG_CONST png_store*  ps = dp->ps;
4714 4715
   int pass;

4716
   for (pass=0; pass<npasses; ++pass)
4717 4718
   {
      png_uint_32 y;
4719
      png_uint_32 wPass = PNG_PASS_COLS(width, pass);
4720

4721
      for (y=0; y<height; ++y)
4722
      {
4723 4724 4725 4726 4727 4728 4729 4730 4731 4732 4733 4734 4735 4736
         if (do_interlace)
         {
            /* wPass may be zero or this row may not be in this pass.
             * png_read_row must not be called in either case.
             */
            if (wPass > 0 && PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass))
            {
               /* Read the row into a pair of temporary buffers, then do the
                * merge here into the output rows.
                */
               png_byte row[STANDARD_ROWMAX], display[STANDARD_ROWMAX];

               /* The following aids (to some extent) error detection - we can
                * see where png_read_row wrote.  Use opposite values in row and
4737 4738 4739
                * display to make this easier.  Don't use 0xff (which is used in
                * the image write code to fill unused bits) or 0 (which is a
                * likely value to overwrite unused bits with).
4740
                */
4741 4742
               memset(row, 0xc5, sizeof row);
               memset(display, 0x5c, sizeof display);
4743 4744 4745

               png_read_row(pp, row, display);

4746 4747 4748
               if (iImage >= 0)
                  deinterlace_row(store_image_row(ps, pp, iImage, y), row,
                     dp->pixel_size, dp->w, pass);
4749

4750 4751 4752
               if (iDisplay >= 0)
                  deinterlace_row(store_image_row(ps, pp, iDisplay, y), display,
                     dp->pixel_size, dp->w, pass);
4753 4754 4755
            }
         }
         else
4756 4757 4758
            png_read_row(pp,
               iImage >= 0 ? store_image_row(ps, pp, iImage, y) : NULL,
               iDisplay >= 0 ? store_image_row(ps, pp, iDisplay, y) : NULL);
4759 4760 4761 4762 4763 4764 4765 4766 4767
      }
   }

   /* And finish the read operation (only really necessary if the caller wants
    * to find additional data in png_info from chunks after the last IDAT.)
    */
   png_read_end(pp, pi);
}

4768 4769 4770 4771 4772 4773 4774 4775 4776 4777 4778 4779 4780 4781 4782 4783 4784 4785 4786 4787 4788 4789 4790 4791 4792 4793 4794 4795 4796 4797 4798 4799 4800 4801 4802 4803 4804 4805 4806 4807 4808 4809 4810 4811 4812 4813 4814 4815 4816 4817 4818 4819 4820 4821 4822 4823 4824 4825 4826 4827 4828 4829 4830 4831 4832 4833 4834 4835 4836 4837 4838 4839 4840 4841 4842 4843 4844 4845 4846 4847 4848 4849 4850 4851
#ifdef PNG_TEXT_SUPPORTED
static void
standard_check_text(png_const_structp pp, png_const_textp tp,
   png_const_charp keyword, png_const_charp text)
{
   char msg[1024];
   size_t pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, 0, "text: ");
   size_t ok;

   pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, keyword);
   pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ": ");
   ok = pos;

   if (tp->compression != TEXT_COMPRESSION)
   {
      char buf[64];

      sprintf(buf, "compression [%d->%d], ", TEXT_COMPRESSION,
         tp->compression);
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, buf);
   }

   if (tp->key == NULL || strcmp(tp->key, keyword) != 0)
   {
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "keyword \"");
      if (tp->key != NULL)
      {
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, tp->key);
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\", ");
      }

      else
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "null, ");
   }

   if (tp->text == NULL)
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "text lost, ");

   else
   {
      if (tp->text_length != strlen(text))
      {
         char buf[64];
         sprintf(buf, "text length changed[%lu->%lu], ",
            (unsigned long)strlen(text), (unsigned long)tp->text_length);
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, buf);
      }

      if (strcmp(tp->text, text) != 0)
      {
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "text becomes \"");
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, tp->text);
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\" (was \"");
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, text);
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\"), ");
      }
   }

   if (tp->itxt_length != 0)
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "iTXt length set, ");

   if (tp->lang != NULL)
   {
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "iTXt language \"");
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, tp->lang);
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\", ");
   }

   if (tp->lang_key != NULL)
   {
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "iTXt keyword \"");
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, tp->lang_key);
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\", ");
   }

   if (pos > ok)
   {
      msg[pos-2] = '\0'; /* Remove the ", " at the end */
      png_error(pp, msg);
   }
}

static void
standard_text_validate(standard_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
4852
   png_infop pi, int check_end)
4853 4854 4855 4856 4857 4858 4859
{
   png_textp tp = NULL;
   png_uint_32 num_text = png_get_text(pp, pi, &tp, NULL);

   if (num_text == 2 && tp != NULL)
   {
      standard_check_text(pp, tp, "image name", dp->ps->current->name);
4860 4861 4862 4863 4864 4865 4866

      /* This exists because prior to 1.6 the progressive reader left the
       * png_struct z_stream unreset at the end of the image, so subsequent
       * attempts to use it simply returns Z_STREAM_END.
       */
      if (check_end)
         standard_check_text(pp, tp+1, "end marker", "end");
4867 4868 4869 4870 4871 4872 4873 4874 4875 4876 4877 4878
   }

   else
   {
      char msg[64];

      sprintf(msg, "expected two text items, got %lu",
         (unsigned long)num_text);
      png_error(pp, msg);
   }
}
#else
4879
#  define standard_text_validate(dp,pp,pi,check_end) ((void)0)
4880 4881
#endif

4882
static void
4883
standard_row_validate(standard_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
4884
   int iImage, int iDisplay, png_uint_32 y)
4885
{
4886
   int where;
4887 4888
   png_byte std[STANDARD_ROWMAX];

4889 4890 4891 4892
   /* The row must be pre-initialized to the magic number here for the size
    * tests to pass:
    */
   memset(std, 178, sizeof std);
4893 4894 4895 4896 4897 4898
   standard_row(pp, std, dp->id, y);

   /* At the end both the 'row' and 'display' arrays should end up identical.
    * In earlier passes 'row' will be partially filled in, with only the pixels
    * that have been read so far, but 'display' will have those pixels
    * replicated to fill the unread pixels while reading an interlaced image.
4899
#if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10506
4900 4901 4902 4903 4904 4905
    * The side effect inside the libpng sequential reader is that the 'row'
    * array retains the correct values for unwritten pixels within the row
    * bytes, while the 'display' array gets bits off the end of the image (in
    * the last byte) trashed.  Unfortunately in the progressive reader the
    * row bytes are always trashed, so we always do a pixel_cmp here even though
    * a memcmp of all cbRow bytes will succeed for the sequential reader.
4906
#endif
4907
    */
4908 4909 4910
   if (iImage >= 0 &&
      (where = pixel_cmp(std, store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, iImage, y),
            dp->bit_width)) != 0)
4911 4912
   {
      char msg[64];
4913 4914
      sprintf(msg, "PNG image row[%lu][%d] changed from %.2x to %.2x",
         (unsigned long)y, where-1, std[where-1],
4915
         store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, iImage, y)[where-1]);
4916 4917 4918
      png_error(pp, msg);
   }

4919
#if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10506
4920 4921
   /* In this case use pixel_cmp because we need to compare a partial
    * byte at the end of the row if the row is not an exact multiple
4922 4923
    * of 8 bits wide.  (This is fixed in libpng-1.5.6 and pixel_cmp is
    * changed to match!)
4924
    */
4925
#endif
4926 4927 4928
   if (iDisplay >= 0 &&
      (where = pixel_cmp(std, store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, iDisplay, y),
         dp->bit_width)) != 0)
4929 4930
   {
      char msg[64];
4931 4932
      sprintf(msg, "display  row[%lu][%d] changed from %.2x to %.2x",
         (unsigned long)y, where-1, std[where-1],
4933
         store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, iDisplay, y)[where-1]);
4934 4935 4936 4937 4938
      png_error(pp, msg);
   }
}

static void
4939
standard_image_validate(standard_display *dp, png_const_structp pp, int iImage,
4940
    int iDisplay)
4941 4942 4943
{
   png_uint_32 y;

4944 4945
   if (iImage >= 0)
      store_image_check(dp->ps, pp, iImage);
4946

4947 4948
   if (iDisplay >= 0)
      store_image_check(dp->ps, pp, iDisplay);
4949

4950 4951
   for (y=0; y<dp->h; ++y)
      standard_row_validate(dp, pp, iImage, iDisplay, y);
4952 4953

   /* This avoids false positives if the validation code is never called! */
4954
   dp->ps->validated = 1;
4955 4956 4957
}

static void
4958
standard_end(png_structp ppIn, png_infop pi)
4959
{
4960
   png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
4961 4962
   standard_display *dp = voidcast(standard_display*,
      png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
4963

4964
   UNUSED(pi)
4965 4966 4967 4968

   /* Validate the image - progressive reading only produces one variant for
    * interlaced images.
    */
4969 4970
   standard_text_validate(dp, pp, pi,
      PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10600/*check_end: see comments above*/);
4971
   standard_image_validate(dp, pp, 0, -1);
4972 4973
}

4974
/* A single test run checking the standard image to ensure it is not damaged. */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4975
static void
4976
standard_test(png_store* PNG_CONST psIn, png_uint_32 PNG_CONST id,
4977
   int do_interlace, int use_update_info)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4978
{
4979 4980 4981 4982 4983 4984
   standard_display d;
   context(psIn, fault);

   /* Set up the display (stack frame) variables from the arguments to the
    * function and initialize the locals that are filled in later.
    */
4985
   standard_display_init(&d, psIn, id, do_interlace, use_update_info);
4986

4987 4988 4989
   /* Everything is protected by a Try/Catch.  The functions called also
    * typically have local Try/Catch blocks.
    */
4990 4991
   Try
   {
4992 4993 4994
      png_structp pp;
      png_infop pi;

4995
      /* Get a png_struct for reading the image. This will throw an error if it
4996 4997
       * fails, so we don't need to check the result.
       */
4998
      pp = set_store_for_read(d.ps, &pi, d.id,
4999 5000 5001 5002
         d.do_interlace ?  (d.ps->progressive ?
            "pngvalid progressive deinterlacer" :
            "pngvalid sequential deinterlacer") : (d.ps->progressive ?
               "progressive reader" : "sequential reader"));
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5003

5004 5005 5006
      /* Initialize the palette correctly from the png_store_file. */
      standard_palette_init(&d);

5007
      /* Introduce the correct read function. */
5008
      if (d.ps->progressive)
5009
      {
5010 5011
         png_set_progressive_read_fn(pp, &d, standard_info, progressive_row,
            standard_end);
5012

5013
         /* Now feed data into the reader until we reach the end: */
5014
         store_progressive_read(d.ps, pp, pi);
5015
      }
5016 5017
      else
      {
5018 5019
         /* Note that this takes the store, not the display. */
         png_set_read_fn(pp, d.ps, store_read);
5020

5021 5022
         /* Check the header values: */
         png_read_info(pp, pi);
5023

5024 5025 5026
         /* The code tests both versions of the images that the sequential
          * reader can produce.
          */
5027
         standard_info_imp(&d, pp, pi, 2 /*images*/);
5028

5029
         /* Need the total bytes in the image below; we can't get to this point
5030 5031 5032
          * unless the PNG file values have been checked against the expected
          * values.
          */
5033
         {
5034
            sequential_row(&d, pp, pi, 0, 1);
5035 5036 5037 5038

            /* After the last pass loop over the rows again to check that the
             * image is correct.
             */
5039
            if (!d.speed)
5040
            {
5041
               standard_text_validate(&d, pp, pi, 1/*check_end*/);
5042
               standard_image_validate(&d, pp, 0, 1);
5043
            }
5044 5045
            else
               d.ps->validated = 1;
5046
         }
5047
      }
5048

5049
      /* Check for validation. */
5050
      if (!d.ps->validated)
5051
         png_error(pp, "image read failed silently");
5052

5053
      /* Successful completion. */
5054
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5055

5056
   Catch(fault)
5057 5058 5059 5060
      d.ps = fault; /* make sure this hasn't been clobbered. */

   /* In either case clean up the store. */
   store_read_reset(d.ps);
5061
}
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5062

5063 5064
static int
test_standard(png_modifier* PNG_CONST pm, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type,
5065
    int bdlo, int PNG_CONST bdhi)
5066 5067 5068
{
   for (; bdlo <= bdhi; ++bdlo)
   {
5069
      int interlace_type;
5070

5071 5072 5073
      for (interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
           interlace_type < PNG_INTERLACE_LAST; ++interlace_type)
      {
5074
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
5075
            interlace_type, 0, 0, 0), 0/*do_interlace*/, pm->use_update_info);
5076 5077 5078 5079

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5080
   }
5081

5082
   return 1; /* keep going */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5083 5084 5085 5086 5087
}

static void
perform_standard_test(png_modifier *pm)
{
5088 5089 5090
   /* Test each colour type over the valid range of bit depths (expressed as
    * log2(bit_depth) in turn, stop as soon as any error is detected.
    */
5091
   if (!test_standard(pm, 0, 0, READ_BDHI))
5092 5093
      return;

5094
   if (!test_standard(pm, 2, 3, READ_BDHI))
5095 5096
      return;

5097
   if (!test_standard(pm, 3, 0, 3))
5098 5099
      return;

5100
   if (!test_standard(pm, 4, 3, READ_BDHI))
5101 5102
      return;

5103
   if (!test_standard(pm, 6, 3, READ_BDHI))
5104
      return;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5105 5106 5107
}


5108 5109 5110 5111 5112 5113 5114 5115 5116 5117 5118 5119 5120 5121 5122 5123 5124 5125 5126 5127 5128 5129 5130 5131 5132
/********************************** SIZE TESTS ********************************/
static int
test_size(png_modifier* PNG_CONST pm, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type,
    int bdlo, int PNG_CONST bdhi)
{
   /* Run the tests on each combination.
    *
    * NOTE: on my 32 bit x86 each of the following blocks takes
    * a total of 3.5 seconds if done across every combo of bit depth
    * width and height.  This is a waste of time in practice, hence the
    * hinc and winc stuff:
    */
   static PNG_CONST png_byte hinc[] = {1, 3, 11, 1, 5};
   static PNG_CONST png_byte winc[] = {1, 9, 5, 7, 1};
   for (; bdlo <= bdhi; ++bdlo)
   {
      png_uint_32 h, w;

      for (h=1; h<=16; h+=hinc[bdlo]) for (w=1; w<=16; w+=winc[bdlo])
      {
         /* First test all the 'size' images against the sequential
          * reader using libpng to deinterlace (where required.)  This
          * validates the write side of libpng.  There are four possibilities
          * to validate.
          */
5133
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
5134 5135
            PNG_INTERLACE_NONE, w, h, 0), 0/*do_interlace*/,
            pm->use_update_info);
5136 5137 5138 5139

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;

5140
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
5141 5142
            PNG_INTERLACE_NONE, w, h, 1), 0/*do_interlace*/,
            pm->use_update_info);
5143 5144 5145 5146

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;

5147
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
5148 5149
            PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7, w, h, 0), 0/*do_interlace*/,
            pm->use_update_info);
5150 5151 5152 5153

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;

5154
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
5155 5156
            PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7, w, h, 1), 0/*do_interlace*/,
            pm->use_update_info);
5157 5158 5159 5160 5161 5162 5163 5164

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;

         /* Now validate the interlaced read side - do_interlace true,
          * in the progressive case this does actually make a difference
          * to the code used in the non-interlaced case too.
          */
5165
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
5166 5167
            PNG_INTERLACE_NONE, w, h, 0), 1/*do_interlace*/,
            pm->use_update_info);
5168 5169 5170 5171

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;

5172
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
5173 5174
            PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7, w, h, 0), 1/*do_interlace*/,
            pm->use_update_info);
5175 5176 5177 5178 5179 5180 5181 5182 5183 5184 5185 5186 5187 5188 5189 5190 5191 5192 5193 5194 5195 5196

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;
      }
   }

   return 1; /* keep going */
}

static void
perform_size_test(png_modifier *pm)
{
   /* Test each colour type over the valid range of bit depths (expressed as
    * log2(bit_depth) in turn, stop as soon as any error is detected.
    */
   if (!test_size(pm, 0, 0, READ_BDHI))
      return;

   if (!test_size(pm, 2, 3, READ_BDHI))
      return;

   /* For the moment don't do the palette test - it's a waste of time when
5197
    * compared to the grayscale test.
5198 5199 5200 5201 5202 5203 5204 5205 5206 5207 5208 5209 5210 5211
    */
#if 0
   if (!test_size(pm, 3, 0, 3))
      return;
#endif

   if (!test_size(pm, 4, 3, READ_BDHI))
      return;

   if (!test_size(pm, 6, 3, READ_BDHI))
      return;
}


5212
/******************************* TRANSFORM TESTS ******************************/
5213
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
5214 5215 5216 5217 5218 5219
/* A set of tests to validate libpng image transforms.  The possibilities here
 * are legion because the transforms can be combined in a combinatorial
 * fashion.  To deal with this some measure of restraint is required, otherwise
 * the tests would take forever.
 */
typedef struct image_pixel
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5220
{
5221 5222 5223 5224 5225 5226
   /* A local (pngvalid) representation of a PNG pixel, in all its
    * various forms.
    */
   unsigned int red, green, blue, alpha; /* For non-palette images. */
   unsigned int palette_index;           /* For a palette image. */
   png_byte colour_type;                 /* As in the spec. */
5227 5228
   png_byte bit_depth;                   /* Defines bit size in row */
   png_byte sample_depth;                /* Scale of samples */
5229 5230 5231 5232 5233 5234 5235 5236 5237 5238 5239 5240 5241
   int      have_tRNS;                   /* tRNS chunk may need processing */

   /* For checking the code calculates double precision floating point values
    * along with an error value, accumulated from the transforms.  Because an
    * sBIT setting allows larger error bounds (indeed, by the spec, apparently
    * up to just less than +/-1 in the scaled value) the *lowest* sBIT for each
    * channel is stored.  This sBIT value is folded in to the stored error value
    * at the end of the application of the transforms to the pixel.
    */
   double   redf, greenf, bluef, alphaf;
   double   rede, greene, bluee, alphae;
   png_byte red_sBIT, green_sBIT, blue_sBIT, alpha_sBIT;
} image_pixel;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5242

5243 5244 5245
/* Shared utility function, see below. */
static void
image_pixel_setf(image_pixel *this, unsigned int max)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5246
{
5247 5248 5249 5250 5251 5252 5253 5254 5255 5256 5257 5258 5259 5260 5261 5262 5263 5264 5265 5266 5267
   this->redf = this->red / (double)max;
   this->greenf = this->green / (double)max;
   this->bluef = this->blue / (double)max;
   this->alphaf = this->alpha / (double)max;

   if (this->red < max)
      this->rede = this->redf * DBL_EPSILON;
   else
      this->rede = 0;
   if (this->green < max)
      this->greene = this->greenf * DBL_EPSILON;
   else
      this->greene = 0;
   if (this->blue < max)
      this->bluee = this->bluef * DBL_EPSILON;
   else
      this->bluee = 0;
   if (this->alpha < max)
      this->alphae = this->alphaf * DBL_EPSILON;
   else
      this->alphae = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5268 5269
}

5270 5271 5272 5273
/* Initialize the structure for the next pixel - call this before doing any
 * transforms and call it for each pixel since all the fields may need to be
 * reset.
 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5274
static void
5275
image_pixel_init(image_pixel *this, png_const_bytep row, png_byte colour_type,
5276
    png_byte bit_depth, png_uint_32 x, store_palette palette)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5277
{
5278 5279 5280
   PNG_CONST png_byte sample_depth = (png_byte)(colour_type ==
      PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE ? 8 : bit_depth);
   PNG_CONST unsigned int max = (1U<<sample_depth)-1;
G
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5281

5282 5283 5284 5285 5286 5287 5288 5289
   /* Initially just set everything to the same number and the alpha to opaque.
    * Note that this currently assumes a simple palette where entry x has colour
    * rgb(x,x,x)!
    */
   this->palette_index = this->red = this->green = this->blue =
      sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, 0);
   this->alpha = max;
   this->red_sBIT = this->green_sBIT = this->blue_sBIT = this->alpha_sBIT =
5290 5291 5292 5293 5294 5295 5296 5297 5298
      sample_depth;

   /* Then override as appropriate: */
   if (colour_type == 3) /* palette */
   {
      /* This permits the caller to default to the sample value. */
      if (palette != 0)
      {
         PNG_CONST unsigned int i = this->palette_index;
5299

5300 5301 5302 5303 5304 5305 5306 5307
         this->red = palette[i].red;
         this->green = palette[i].green;
         this->blue = palette[i].blue;
         this->alpha = palette[i].alpha;
      }
   }

   else /* not palette */
5308
   {
5309 5310 5311 5312 5313 5314 5315 5316 5317 5318
      unsigned int i = 0;

      if (colour_type & 2)
      {
         this->green = sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, 1);
         this->blue = sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, 2);
         i = 2;
      }
      if (colour_type & 4)
         this->alpha = sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, ++i);
5319
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5320

5321 5322 5323 5324 5325
   /* Calculate the scaled values, these are simply the values divided by
    * 'max' and the error is initialized to the double precision epsilon value
    * from the header file.
    */
   image_pixel_setf(this, max);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5326

5327 5328 5329 5330 5331
   /* Store the input information for use in the transforms - these will
    * modify the information.
    */
   this->colour_type = colour_type;
   this->bit_depth = bit_depth;
5332
   this->sample_depth = sample_depth;
5333
   this->have_tRNS = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5334 5335
}

5336
/* Convert a palette image to an rgb image.  This necessarily converts the tRNS
5337 5338 5339 5340 5341
 * chunk at the same time, because the tRNS will be in palette form.  The way
 * palette validation works means that the original palette is never updated,
 * instead the image_pixel value from the row contains the RGB of the
 * corresponding palette entry and *this* is updated.  Consequently this routine
 * only needs to change the colour type information.
5342
 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5343
static void
5344
image_pixel_convert_PLTE(image_pixel *this)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5345
{
5346
   if (this->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5347
   {
5348 5349 5350 5351 5352 5353 5354 5355
      if (this->have_tRNS)
      {
         this->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA;
         this->have_tRNS = 0;
      }
      else
         this->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;

5356 5357
      /* The bit depth of the row changes at this point too (notice that this is
       * the row format, not the sample depth, which is separate.)
5358
       */
5359
      this->bit_depth = 8;
5360
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5361 5362
}

5363
/* Add an alpha channel; this will import the tRNS information because tRNS is
5364 5365 5366 5367
 * not valid in an alpha image.  The bit depth will invariably be set to at
 * least 8.  Palette images will be converted to alpha (using the above API).
 */
static void
5368
image_pixel_add_alpha(image_pixel *this, PNG_CONST standard_display *display)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5369
{
5370
   if (this->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
5371
      image_pixel_convert_PLTE(this);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5372

5373
   if ((this->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) == 0)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5374
   {
5375
      if (this->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5376
      {
5377 5378
         if (this->bit_depth < 8)
            this->bit_depth = 8;
5379

5380 5381 5382
         if (this->have_tRNS)
         {
            this->have_tRNS = 0;
5383

5384 5385 5386 5387 5388 5389 5390 5391 5392 5393
            /* Check the input, original, channel value here against the
             * original tRNS gray chunk valie.
             */
            if (this->red == display->transparent.red)
               this->alphaf = 0;
            else
               this->alphaf = 1;
         }
         else
            this->alphaf = 1;
5394

5395
         this->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5396 5397
      }

5398 5399 5400 5401 5402
      else if (this->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB)
      {
         if (this->have_tRNS)
         {
            this->have_tRNS = 0;
5403

5404 5405 5406 5407 5408 5409 5410 5411 5412
            /* Again, check the exact input values, not the current transformed
             * value!
             */
            if (this->red == display->transparent.red &&
               this->green == display->transparent.green &&
               this->blue == display->transparent.blue)
               this->alphaf = 0;
            else
               this->alphaf = 1;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5413

5414 5415 5416 5417 5418 5419 5420 5421 5422
            this->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA;
         }
      }

      /* The error in the alpha is zero and the sBIT value comes from the
       * original sBIT data (actually it will always be the original bit depth).
       */
      this->alphae = 0;
      this->alpha_sBIT = display->alpha_sBIT;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5423 5424 5425
   }
}

5426 5427
struct transform_display;
typedef struct image_transform
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5428
{
5429 5430 5431 5432 5433 5434
   /* The name of this transform: a string. */
   PNG_CONST char *name;

   /* Each transform can be disabled from the command line: */
   int enable;

5435 5436
   /* The global list of transforms; read only. */
   struct image_transform *PNG_CONST list;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5437

5438 5439 5440 5441 5442 5443 5444 5445 5446 5447 5448 5449 5450 5451 5452 5453
   /* The global count of the number of times this transform has been set on an
    * image.
    */
   unsigned int global_use;

   /* The local count of the number of times this transform has been set. */
   unsigned int local_use;

   /* The next transform in the list, each transform must call its own next
    * transform after it has processed the pixel successfully.
    */
   PNG_CONST struct image_transform *next;

   /* A single transform for the image, expressed as a series of function
    * callbacks and some space for values.
    *
5454 5455 5456 5457 5458 5459 5460
    * First a callback to add any required modifications to the png_modifier;
    * this gets called just before the modifier is set up for read.
    */
   void (*ini)(PNG_CONST struct image_transform *this,
      struct transform_display *that);

   /* And a callback to set the transform on the current png_read_struct:
5461 5462 5463 5464 5465 5466 5467 5468 5469 5470 5471
    */
   void (*set)(PNG_CONST struct image_transform *this,
      struct transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi);

   /* Then a transform that takes an input pixel in one PNG format or another
    * and modifies it by a pngvalid implementation of the transform (thus
    * duplicating the libpng intent without, we hope, duplicating the bugs
    * in the libpng implementation!)  The png_structp is solely to allow error
    * reporting via png_error and png_warning.
    */
   void (*mod)(PNG_CONST struct image_transform *this, image_pixel *that,
5472
      png_const_structp pp, PNG_CONST struct transform_display *display);
5473 5474 5475 5476 5477 5478 5479

   /* Add this transform to the list and return true if the transform is
    * meaningful for this colour type and bit depth - if false then the
    * transform should have no effect on the image so there's not a lot of
    * point running it.
    */
   int (*add)(struct image_transform *this,
5480
      PNG_CONST struct image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type,
5481 5482 5483 5484
      png_byte bit_depth);
} image_transform;

typedef struct transform_display
5485 5486 5487 5488
{
   standard_display this;

   /* Parameters */
5489 5490
   png_modifier*              pm;
   PNG_CONST image_transform* transform_list;
5491 5492

   /* Local variables */
5493 5494
   png_byte output_colour_type;
   png_byte output_bit_depth;
5495

5496 5497 5498 5499
   /* Modifications (not necessarily used.) */
   gama_modification gama_mod;
   chrm_modification chrm_mod;
   srgb_modification srgb_mod;
5500
} transform_display;
5501

5502 5503 5504 5505 5506 5507 5508 5509 5510 5511 5512 5513 5514 5515 5516 5517 5518 5519 5520 5521 5522 5523 5524 5525 5526 5527 5528 5529 5530 5531 5532 5533 5534 5535 5536 5537
/* Set sRGB, cHRM and gAMA transforms as required by the current encoding. */
static void
transform_set_encoding(transform_display *this)
{
   /* Set up the png_modifier '_current' fields then use these to determine how
    * to add appropriate chunks.
    */
   png_modifier *pm = this->pm;

   modifier_set_encoding(pm);

   if (modifier_color_encoding_is_set(pm))
   {
      if (modifier_color_encoding_is_sRGB(pm))
         srgb_modification_init(&this->srgb_mod, pm, PNG_sRGB_INTENT_ABSOLUTE);

      else
      {
         /* Set gAMA and cHRM separately. */
         gama_modification_init(&this->gama_mod, pm, pm->current_gamma);

         if (pm->current_encoding != 0)
            chrm_modification_init(&this->chrm_mod, pm, pm->current_encoding);
      }
   }
}

/* Three functions to end the list: */
static void
image_transform_ini_end(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
   transform_display *that)
{
   UNUSED(this)
   UNUSED(that)
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5538
static void
5539 5540
image_transform_set_end(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
   transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5541
{
5542 5543 5544 5545
   UNUSED(this)
   UNUSED(that)
   UNUSED(pp)
   UNUSED(pi)
5546
}
5547

5548 5549 5550 5551 5552 5553 5554 5555 5556 5557 5558 5559 5560 5561 5562 5563 5564 5565 5566
/* At the end of the list recalculate the output image pixel value from the
 * double precision values set up by the preceding 'mod' calls:
 */
static unsigned int
sample_scale(double sample_value, unsigned int scale)
{
   sample_value = floor(sample_value * scale + .5);

   /* Return NaN as 0: */
   if (!(sample_value > 0))
      sample_value = 0;
   else if (sample_value > scale)
      sample_value = scale;

   return (unsigned int)sample_value;
}

static void
image_transform_mod_end(PNG_CONST image_transform *this, image_pixel *that,
5567
    png_const_structp pp, PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
5568
{
5569
   PNG_CONST unsigned int scale = (1U<<that->sample_depth)-1;
5570

5571 5572 5573
   UNUSED(this)
   UNUSED(pp)
   UNUSED(display)
5574

5575 5576 5577 5578
   /* At the end recalculate the digitized red green and blue values according
    * to the current sample_depth of the pixel.
    *
    * The sample value is simply scaled to the maximum, checking for over
5579 5580 5581 5582 5583 5584 5585 5586 5587 5588
    * and underflow (which can both happen for some image transforms,
    * including simple size scaling, though libpng doesn't do that at present.
    */
   that->red = sample_scale(that->redf, scale);

   /* The error value is increased, at the end, according to the lowest sBIT
    * value seen.  Common sense tells us that the intermediate integer
    * representations are no more accurate than +/- 0.5 in the integral values,
    * the sBIT allows the implementation to be worse than this.  In addition the
    * PNG specification actually permits any error within the range (-1..+1),
5589 5590 5591 5592
    * but that is ignored here.  Instead the final digitized value is compared,
    * below to the digitized value of the error limits - this has the net effect
    * of allowing (almost) +/-1 in the output value.  It's difficult to see how
    * any algorithm that digitizes intermediate results can be more accurate.
5593 5594 5595 5596 5597 5598 5599 5600 5601 5602 5603 5604 5605 5606 5607 5608 5609
    */
   that->rede += 1./(2*((1U<<that->red_sBIT)-1));

   if (that->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR)
   {
      that->green = sample_scale(that->greenf, scale);
      that->blue = sample_scale(that->bluef, scale);
      that->greene += 1./(2*((1U<<that->green_sBIT)-1));
      that->bluee += 1./(2*((1U<<that->blue_sBIT)-1));
   }
   else
   {
      that->blue = that->green = that->red;
      that->bluef = that->greenf = that->redf;
      that->bluee = that->greene = that->rede;
   }

5610 5611
   if ((that->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) ||
      that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
5612 5613 5614 5615 5616 5617 5618 5619 5620 5621 5622 5623 5624 5625 5626
   {
      that->alpha = sample_scale(that->alphaf, scale);
      that->alphae += 1./(2*((1U<<that->alpha_sBIT)-1));
   }
   else
   {
      that->alpha = scale; /* opaque */
      that->alpha = 1;     /* Override this. */
      that->alphae = 0;    /* It's exact ;-) */
   }
}

/* Static 'end' structure: */
static image_transform image_transform_end =
{
5627 5628
   "(end)", /* name */
   1, /* enable */
5629 5630 5631 5632
   0, /* list */
   0, /* global_use */
   0, /* local_use */
   0, /* next */
5633
   image_transform_ini_end,
5634 5635 5636 5637 5638 5639 5640 5641 5642 5643 5644 5645
   image_transform_set_end,
   image_transform_mod_end,
   0 /* never called, I want it to crash if it is! */
};

/* Reader callbacks and implementations, where they differ from the standard
 * ones.
 */
static void
transform_display_init(transform_display *dp, png_modifier *pm, png_uint_32 id,
    PNG_CONST image_transform *transform_list)
{
5646
   memset(dp, 0, sizeof *dp);
5647

5648
   /* Standard fields */
5649
   standard_display_init(&dp->this, &pm->this, id, 0/*do_interlace*/,
5650
      pm->use_update_info);
5651 5652 5653 5654 5655 5656 5657 5658 5659 5660 5661 5662 5663 5664 5665 5666 5667 5668 5669 5670

   /* Parameter fields */
   dp->pm = pm;
   dp->transform_list = transform_list;

   /* Local variable fields */
   dp->output_colour_type = 255; /* invalid */
   dp->output_bit_depth = 255;  /* invalid */
}

static void
transform_info_imp(transform_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   /* Reuse the standard stuff as appropriate. */
   standard_info_part1(&dp->this, pp, pi);

   /* Now set the list of transforms. */
   dp->transform_list->set(dp->transform_list, dp, pp, pi);

   /* Update the info structure for these transforms: */
5671 5672 5673 5674 5675 5676 5677
   {
      int i = dp->this.use_update_info;
      /* Always do one call, even if use_update_info is 0. */
      do
         png_read_update_info(pp, pi);
      while (--i > 0);
   }
5678 5679 5680 5681 5682 5683 5684 5685 5686 5687 5688 5689 5690 5691 5692 5693 5694 5695 5696 5697 5698 5699 5700 5701 5702 5703 5704 5705 5706 5707 5708 5709 5710 5711 5712 5713 5714 5715 5716 5717 5718 5719 5720 5721 5722 5723 5724 5725 5726 5727

   /* And get the output information into the standard_display */
   standard_info_part2(&dp->this, pp, pi, 1/*images*/);

   /* Plus the extra stuff we need for the transform tests: */
   dp->output_colour_type = png_get_color_type(pp, pi);
   dp->output_bit_depth = png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi);

   /* Validate the combination of colour type and bit depth that we are getting
    * out of libpng; the semantics of something not in the PNG spec are, at
    * best, unclear.
    */
   switch (dp->output_colour_type)
   {
   case PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE:
      if (dp->output_bit_depth > 8) goto error;
      /*FALL THROUGH*/
   case PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY:
      if (dp->output_bit_depth == 1 || dp->output_bit_depth == 2 ||
         dp->output_bit_depth == 4)
         break;
      /*FALL THROUGH*/
   default:
      if (dp->output_bit_depth == 8 || dp->output_bit_depth == 16)
         break;
      /*FALL THROUGH*/
   error:
      {
         char message[128];
         size_t pos;

         pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0,
            "invalid final bit depth: colour type(");
         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_colour_type);
         pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ") with bit depth: ");
         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_bit_depth);

         png_error(pp, message);
      }
   }

   /* Use a test pixel to check that the output agrees with what we expect -
    * this avoids running the whole test if the output is unexpected.
    */
   {
      image_pixel test_pixel;

      memset(&test_pixel, 0, sizeof test_pixel);
      test_pixel.colour_type = dp->this.colour_type; /* input */
      test_pixel.bit_depth = dp->this.bit_depth;
5728 5729 5730 5731
      if (test_pixel.colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
         test_pixel.sample_depth = 8;
      else
         test_pixel.sample_depth = test_pixel.bit_depth;
5732 5733 5734
      /* Don't need sBIT here, but it must be set to non-zero to avoid
       * arithmetic overflows.
       */
5735
      test_pixel.have_tRNS = dp->this.is_transparent;
5736 5737
      test_pixel.red_sBIT = test_pixel.green_sBIT = test_pixel.blue_sBIT =
         test_pixel.alpha_sBIT = test_pixel.sample_depth;
5738 5739 5740 5741 5742 5743 5744 5745 5746 5747 5748 5749 5750 5751 5752 5753 5754 5755 5756 5757 5758 5759 5760 5761 5762 5763

      dp->transform_list->mod(dp->transform_list, &test_pixel, pp, dp);

      if (test_pixel.colour_type != dp->output_colour_type)
      {
         char message[128];
         size_t pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0, "colour type ");

         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_colour_type);
         pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " expected ");
         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, test_pixel.colour_type);

         png_error(pp, message);
      }

      if (test_pixel.bit_depth != dp->output_bit_depth)
      {
         char message[128];
         size_t pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0, "bit depth ");

         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_bit_depth);
         pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " expected ");
         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, test_pixel.bit_depth);

         png_error(pp, message);
      }
5764 5765 5766 5767 5768 5769 5770 5771 5772 5773 5774 5775 5776 5777 5778 5779 5780 5781 5782 5783 5784

      /* If both bit depth and colour type are correct check the sample depth.
       * I believe these are both internal errors.
       */
      if (test_pixel.colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
      {
         if (test_pixel.sample_depth != 8) /* oops - internal error! */
            png_error(pp, "pngvalid: internal: palette sample depth not 8");
      }
      else if (test_pixel.sample_depth != dp->output_bit_depth)
      {
         char message[128];
         size_t pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0,
            "internal: sample depth ");

         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_bit_depth);
         pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " expected ");
         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, test_pixel.sample_depth);

         png_error(pp, message);
      }
5785 5786 5787 5788 5789 5790
   }
}

static void
transform_info(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
5791 5792
   transform_info_imp(voidcast(transform_display*, png_get_progressive_ptr(pp)),
      pp, pi);
5793 5794 5795
}

static void
5796
transform_range_check(png_const_structp pp, unsigned int r, unsigned int g,
5797
   unsigned int b, unsigned int a, unsigned int in_digitized, double in,
5798 5799
   unsigned int out, png_byte sample_depth, double err, double limit,
   PNG_CONST char *name, double digitization_error)
5800 5801 5802 5803
{
   /* Compare the scaled, digitzed, values of our local calculation (in+-err)
    * with the digitized values libpng produced;  'sample_depth' is the actual
    * digitization depth of the libpng output colors (the bit depth except for
5804
    * palette images where it is always 8.)  The check on 'err' is to detect
5805
    * internal errors in pngvalid itself.
5806 5807
    */
   unsigned int max = (1U<<sample_depth)-1;
5808 5809
   double in_min = ceil((in-err)*max - digitization_error);
   double in_max = floor((in+err)*max + digitization_error);
5810
   if (err > limit || !(out >= in_min && out <= in_max))
5811
   {
5812
      char message[256];
5813 5814 5815
      size_t pos;

      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0, name);
5816 5817 5818 5819 5820 5821 5822 5823 5824 5825
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " output value error: rgba(");
      pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, r);
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, g);
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, b);
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, a);
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, "): ");
      pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, out);
5826
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " expected: ");
5827 5828 5829
      pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, in_digitized);
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " (");
      pos = safecatd(message, sizeof message, pos, (in-err)*max, 3);
5830
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, "..");
5831 5832
      pos = safecatd(message, sizeof message, pos, (in+err)*max, 3);
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ")");
5833 5834 5835 5836 5837 5838

      png_error(pp, message);
   }
}

static void
5839 5840
transform_image_validate(transform_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
   png_infop pi)
5841 5842
{
   /* Constants for the loop below: */
5843
   PNG_CONST png_store* PNG_CONST ps = dp->this.ps;
5844 5845 5846 5847 5848 5849
   PNG_CONST png_byte in_ct = dp->this.colour_type;
   PNG_CONST png_byte in_bd = dp->this.bit_depth;
   PNG_CONST png_uint_32 w = dp->this.w;
   PNG_CONST png_uint_32 h = dp->this.h;
   PNG_CONST png_byte out_ct = dp->output_colour_type;
   PNG_CONST png_byte out_bd = dp->output_bit_depth;
5850 5851
   PNG_CONST png_byte sample_depth = (png_byte)(out_ct ==
      PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE ? 8 : out_bd);
5852 5853 5854 5855 5856
   PNG_CONST png_byte red_sBIT = dp->this.red_sBIT;
   PNG_CONST png_byte green_sBIT = dp->this.green_sBIT;
   PNG_CONST png_byte blue_sBIT = dp->this.blue_sBIT;
   PNG_CONST png_byte alpha_sBIT = dp->this.alpha_sBIT;
   PNG_CONST int have_tRNS = dp->this.is_transparent;
5857
   double digitization_error;
5858

5859
   store_palette out_palette;
5860 5861
   png_uint_32 y;

5862 5863
   UNUSED(pi)

5864 5865 5866
   /* Check for row overwrite errors */
   store_image_check(dp->this.ps, pp, 0);

5867 5868 5869 5870
   /* Read the palette corresponding to the output if the output colour type
    * indicates a palette, othewise set out_palette to garbage.
    */
   if (out_ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
5871 5872 5873 5874 5875 5876 5877 5878 5879
   {
      /* Validate that the palette count itself has not changed - this is not
       * expected.
       */
      int npalette = (-1);

      (void)read_palette(out_palette, &npalette, pp, pi);
      if (npalette != dp->this.npalette)
         png_error(pp, "unexpected change in palette size");
5880 5881

      digitization_error = .5;
5882
   }
5883
   else
5884 5885 5886
   {
      png_byte in_sample_depth;

5887 5888
      memset(out_palette, 0x5e, sizeof out_palette);

5889 5890 5891 5892 5893 5894 5895 5896 5897 5898 5899 5900 5901 5902 5903 5904 5905 5906 5907 5908 5909 5910
      /* assume-8-bit-calculations means assume that if the input has 8 bit
       * (or less) samples and the output has 16 bit samples the calculations
       * will be done with 8 bit precision, not 16.
       *
       * TODO: fix this in libpng; png_set_expand_16 should cause 16 bit
       * calculations to be used throughout.
       */
      if (in_ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE || in_bd < 16)
         in_sample_depth = 8;
      else
         in_sample_depth = in_bd;

      if (sample_depth != 16 || in_sample_depth > 8 ||
         !dp->pm->calculations_use_input_precision)
         digitization_error = .5;

      /* Else errors are at 8 bit precision, scale .5 in 8 bits to the 16 bits:
       */
      else
         digitization_error = .5 * 257;
   }

5911
   for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
5912
   {
5913
      png_const_bytep PNG_CONST pRow = store_image_row(ps, pp, 0, y);
5914 5915 5916 5917 5918 5919 5920 5921 5922 5923 5924 5925 5926
      png_uint_32 x;

      /* The original, standard, row pre-transforms. */
      png_byte std[STANDARD_ROWMAX];

      transform_row(pp, std, in_ct, in_bd, y);

      /* Go through each original pixel transforming it and comparing with what
       * libpng did to the same pixel.
       */
      for (x=0; x<w; ++x)
      {
         image_pixel in_pixel, out_pixel;
5927
         unsigned int r, g, b, a;
5928 5929

         /* Find out what we think the pixel should be: */
5930 5931
         image_pixel_init(&in_pixel, std, in_ct, in_bd, x, dp->this.palette);

5932 5933 5934 5935 5936 5937
         in_pixel.red_sBIT = red_sBIT;
         in_pixel.green_sBIT = green_sBIT;
         in_pixel.blue_sBIT = blue_sBIT;
         in_pixel.alpha_sBIT = alpha_sBIT;
         in_pixel.have_tRNS = have_tRNS;

5938 5939 5940 5941 5942 5943
         /* For error detection, below. */
         r = in_pixel.red;
         g = in_pixel.green;
         b = in_pixel.blue;
         a = in_pixel.alpha;

5944 5945 5946
         dp->transform_list->mod(dp->transform_list, &in_pixel, pp, dp);

         /* Read the output pixel and compare it to what we got, we don't
5947
          * use the error field here, so no need to update sBIT.
5948
          */
5949
         image_pixel_init(&out_pixel, pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, out_palette);
5950

5951 5952 5953 5954 5955
         /* We don't expect changes to the index here even if the bit depth is
          * changed.
          */
         if (in_ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE &&
            out_ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
5956 5957 5958 5959 5960
         {
            if (in_pixel.palette_index != out_pixel.palette_index)
               png_error(pp, "unexpected transformed palette index");
         }

5961 5962 5963 5964 5965
         /* Check the colours for palette images too - in fact the palette could
          * be separately verified itself in most cases.
          */
         if (in_pixel.red != out_pixel.red)
            transform_range_check(pp, r, g, b, a, in_pixel.red, in_pixel.redf,
5966 5967
               out_pixel.red, sample_depth, in_pixel.rede,
               dp->pm->limit + 1./(2*((1U<<in_pixel.red_sBIT)-1)), "red/gray",
5968
               digitization_error);
5969 5970 5971 5972 5973

         if ((out_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) != 0 &&
            in_pixel.green != out_pixel.green)
            transform_range_check(pp, r, g, b, a, in_pixel.green,
               in_pixel.greenf, out_pixel.green, sample_depth, in_pixel.greene,
5974 5975
               dp->pm->limit + 1./(2*((1U<<in_pixel.green_sBIT)-1)), "green",
               digitization_error);
5976 5977 5978 5979

         if ((out_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) != 0 &&
            in_pixel.blue != out_pixel.blue)
            transform_range_check(pp, r, g, b, a, in_pixel.blue, in_pixel.bluef,
5980 5981
               out_pixel.blue, sample_depth, in_pixel.bluee,
               dp->pm->limit + 1./(2*((1U<<in_pixel.blue_sBIT)-1)), "blue",
5982
               digitization_error);
5983 5984 5985 5986 5987

         if ((out_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0 &&
            in_pixel.alpha != out_pixel.alpha)
            transform_range_check(pp, r, g, b, a, in_pixel.alpha,
               in_pixel.alphaf, out_pixel.alpha, sample_depth, in_pixel.alphae,
5988 5989
               dp->pm->limit + 1./(2*((1U<<in_pixel.alpha_sBIT)-1)), "alpha",
               digitization_error);
5990 5991 5992 5993 5994 5995 5996 5997
      } /* pixel (x) loop */
   } /* row (y) loop */

   /* Record that something was actually checked to avoid a false positive. */
   dp->this.ps->validated = 1;
}

static void
5998
transform_end(png_structp ppIn, png_infop pi)
5999
{
6000
   png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
6001 6002
   transform_display *dp = voidcast(transform_display*,
      png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
6003

6004 6005 6006 6007
   if (!dp->this.speed)
      transform_image_validate(dp, pp, pi);
   else
      dp->this.ps->validated = 1;
6008 6009 6010 6011 6012
}

/* A single test run. */
static void
transform_test(png_modifier *pmIn, PNG_CONST png_uint_32 idIn,
6013
    PNG_CONST image_transform* transform_listIn, PNG_CONST char * volatile name)
6014 6015 6016 6017 6018 6019 6020 6021
{
   transform_display d;
   context(&pmIn->this, fault);

   transform_display_init(&d, pmIn, idIn, transform_listIn);

   Try
   {
6022
      size_t pos = 0;
6023 6024
      png_structp pp;
      png_infop pi;
6025 6026 6027 6028 6029 6030 6031 6032 6033 6034 6035 6036 6037
      char full_name[256];

      /* Make sure the encoding fields are correct and enter the required
       * modifications.
       */
      transform_set_encoding(&d);

      /* Add any modifications required by the transform list. */
      d.transform_list->ini(d.transform_list, &d);

      /* Add the color space information, if any, to the name. */
      pos = safecat(full_name, sizeof full_name, pos, name);
      pos = safecat_current_encoding(full_name, sizeof full_name, pos, d.pm);
6038

6039
      /* Get a png_struct for reading the image. */
6040
      pp = set_modifier_for_read(d.pm, &pi, d.this.id, full_name);
6041
      standard_palette_init(&d.this);
6042

6043 6044 6045 6046 6047 6048 6049 6050 6051 6052 6053 6054
#     if 0
         /* Logging (debugging only) */
         {
            char buffer[256];

            (void)store_message(&d.pm->this, pp, buffer, sizeof buffer, 0,
               "running test");

            fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", buffer);
         }
#     endif

6055 6056 6057 6058 6059 6060 6061 6062 6063 6064 6065 6066 6067 6068 6069 6070 6071 6072 6073 6074 6075
      /* Introduce the correct read function. */
      if (d.pm->this.progressive)
      {
         /* Share the row function with the standard implementation. */
         png_set_progressive_read_fn(pp, &d, transform_info, progressive_row,
            transform_end);

         /* Now feed data into the reader until we reach the end: */
         modifier_progressive_read(d.pm, pp, pi);
      }
      else
      {
         /* modifier_read expects a png_modifier* */
         png_set_read_fn(pp, d.pm, modifier_read);

         /* Check the header values: */
         png_read_info(pp, pi);

         /* Process the 'info' requirements. Only one image is generated */
         transform_info_imp(&d, pp, pi);

6076
         sequential_row(&d.this, pp, pi, -1, 0);
6077

6078 6079
         if (!d.this.speed)
            transform_image_validate(&d, pp, pi);
6080 6081
         else
            d.this.ps->validated = 1;
6082 6083 6084 6085 6086 6087
      }

      modifier_reset(d.pm);
   }

   Catch(fault)
6088
   {
6089
      modifier_reset(voidcast(png_modifier*,(void*)fault));
6090
   }
6091 6092 6093 6094
}

/* The transforms: */
#define ITSTRUCT(name) image_transform_##name
6095 6096
#define ITDATA(name) image_transform_data_##name
#define image_transform_ini image_transform_default_ini
6097
#define IT(name)\
6098 6099
static image_transform ITSTRUCT(name) =\
{\
6100 6101
   #name,\
   1, /*enable*/\
6102
   &PT, /*list*/\
6103 6104 6105
   0, /*global_use*/\
   0, /*local_use*/\
   0, /*next*/\
6106
   image_transform_ini,\
6107 6108 6109 6110
   image_transform_png_set_##name##_set,\
   image_transform_png_set_##name##_mod,\
   image_transform_png_set_##name##_add\
}
6111
#define PT ITSTRUCT(end) /* stores the previous transform */
6112

6113
/* To save code: */
6114 6115 6116 6117 6118 6119 6120
static void
image_transform_default_ini(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that)
{
   this->next->ini(this->next, that);
}

6121
#ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
6122
static int
6123 6124
image_transform_default_add(image_transform *this,
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
6125
{
6126 6127 6128
   UNUSED(colour_type)
   UNUSED(bit_depth)

6129 6130 6131
   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

6132
   return 1;
6133
}
6134
#endif
6135

6136
#ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED
6137 6138 6139 6140 6141 6142 6143 6144 6145 6146 6147
/* png_set_palette_to_rgb */
static void
image_transform_png_set_palette_to_rgb_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_palette_to_rgb(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_palette_to_rgb_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6148 6149
    image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
    PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
6150 6151
{
   if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6152
      image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
6153 6154 6155 6156 6157 6158

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_palette_to_rgb_add(image_transform *this,
6159
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
6160
{
6161
   UNUSED(bit_depth)
6162 6163 6164 6165 6166 6167 6168

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   return colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE;
}

6169 6170 6171 6172
IT(palette_to_rgb);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(palette_to_rgb)
#endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED */
6173

6174
#ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED
6175 6176 6177 6178 6179 6180 6181 6182 6183 6184 6185
/* png_set_tRNS_to_alpha */
static void
image_transform_png_set_tRNS_to_alpha_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
   transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_tRNS_to_alpha(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_tRNS_to_alpha_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6186 6187
   image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
   PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
6188
{
6189 6190
   /* LIBPNG BUG: this always forces palette images to RGB. */
   if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6191
      image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
6192

6193
   /* This effectively does an 'expand' only if there is some transparency to
6194
    * convert to an alpha channel.
6195 6196 6197 6198 6199
    */
   if (that->have_tRNS)
      image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this);

   /* LIBPNG BUG: otherwise libpng still expands to 8 bits! */
6200 6201 6202 6203 6204 6205 6206
   else
   {
      if (that->bit_depth < 8)
         that->bit_depth =8;
      if (that->sample_depth < 8)
         that->sample_depth = 8;
   }
6207 6208 6209 6210 6211 6212

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_tRNS_to_alpha_add(image_transform *this,
6213
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
6214
{
6215
   UNUSED(bit_depth)
6216 6217 6218 6219 6220 6221 6222 6223 6224 6225 6226

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   /* We don't know yet whether there will be a tRNS chunk, but we know that
    * this transformation should do nothing if there already is an alpha
    * channel.
    */
   return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) == 0;
}

6227 6228 6229 6230
IT(tRNS_to_alpha);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(tRNS_to_alpha)
#endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED */
6231

6232
#ifdef PNG_READ_GRAY_TO_RGB_SUPPORTED
6233 6234 6235 6236 6237 6238 6239 6240 6241 6242 6243
/* png_set_gray_to_rgb */
static void
image_transform_png_set_gray_to_rgb_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_gray_to_rgb(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_gray_to_rgb_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6244 6245
    image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
    PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
6246 6247 6248 6249 6250 6251 6252 6253 6254 6255 6256 6257 6258 6259
{
   /* NOTE: we can actually pend the tRNS processing at this point because we
    * can correctly recognize the original pixel value even though we have
    * mapped the one gray channel to the three RGB ones, but in fact libpng
    * doesn't do this, so we don't either.
    */
   if ((that->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) == 0 && that->have_tRNS)
      image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this);

   /* Simply expand the bit depth and alter the colour type as required. */
   if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY)
   {
      /* RGB images have a bit depth at least equal to '8' */
      if (that->bit_depth < 8)
6260
         that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 8;
6261 6262 6263 6264 6265 6266 6267 6268 6269 6270 6271 6272 6273 6274 6275

      /* And just changing the colour type works here because the green and blue
       * channels are being maintained in lock-step with the red/gray:
       */
      that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;
   }

   else if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA)
      that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA;

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_gray_to_rgb_add(image_transform *this,
6276
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
6277
{
6278
   UNUSED(bit_depth)
6279 6280 6281 6282 6283 6284 6285

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) == 0;
}

6286 6287 6288 6289
IT(gray_to_rgb);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(gray_to_rgb)
#endif /* PNG_READ_GRAY_TO_RGB_SUPPORTED */
6290

6291
#ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED
6292 6293 6294 6295 6296 6297 6298 6299 6300 6301 6302
/* png_set_expand */
static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_expand(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6303 6304
    image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
    PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
6305 6306 6307
{
   /* The general expand case depends on what the colour type is: */
   if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6308
      image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
6309 6310
   else if (that->bit_depth < 8) /* grayscale */
      that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 8;
6311 6312 6313 6314 6315 6316 6317 6318 6319

   if (that->have_tRNS)
      image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this);

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_expand_add(image_transform *this,
6320
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
6321
{
6322
   UNUSED(bit_depth)
6323 6324 6325 6326 6327 6328 6329 6330 6331 6332

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   /* 'expand' should do nothing for RGBA or GA input - no tRNS and the bit
    * depth is at least 8 already.
    */
   return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) == 0;
}

6333 6334 6335 6336
IT(expand);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(expand)
#endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED */
6337

6338
#ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED
6339 6340 6341 6342 6343 6344 6345 6346 6347 6348 6349 6350 6351 6352
/* png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8
 * LIBPNG BUG: this just does an 'expand'
 */
static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8_set(
    PNG_CONST image_transform *this, transform_display *that, png_structp pp,
    png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8_mod(
6353
    PNG_CONST image_transform *this, image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
6354 6355 6356 6357 6358 6359 6360 6361 6362 6363 6364 6365 6366
    PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
   image_transform_png_set_expand_mod(this, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8_add(image_transform *this,
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
{
   return image_transform_png_set_expand_add(this, that, colour_type,
      bit_depth);
}

6367 6368 6369 6370 6371 6372
IT(expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8)
#endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED */

#ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_16_SUPPORTED
6373 6374 6375 6376 6377 6378 6379 6380 6381 6382 6383
/* png_set_expand_16 */
static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_16_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_expand_16(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_16_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6384 6385
    image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
    PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
6386 6387 6388 6389 6390
{
   /* Expect expand_16 to expand everything to 16 bits as a result of also
    * causing 'expand' to happen.
    */
   if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6391
      image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
6392 6393 6394 6395 6396 6397 6398 6399 6400 6401 6402 6403 6404 6405 6406 6407 6408 6409 6410 6411 6412 6413 6414

   if (that->have_tRNS)
      image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this);

   if (that->bit_depth < 16)
      that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 16;

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_expand_16_add(image_transform *this,
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
{
   UNUSED(colour_type)

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   /* expand_16 does something unless the bit depth is already 16. */
   return bit_depth < 16;
}

6415 6416 6417 6418
IT(expand_16);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(expand_16)
#endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_16_SUPPORTED */
6419

6420
#ifdef PNG_READ_SCALE_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED  /* API added in 1.5.4 */
6421
/* png_set_scale_16 */
6422
static void
6423
image_transform_png_set_scale_16_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6424 6425
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
6426
   png_set_scale_16(pp);
6427 6428 6429 6430
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
6431
image_transform_png_set_scale_16_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6432 6433
    image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
    PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
6434 6435 6436
{
   if (that->bit_depth == 16)
   {
6437
      that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 8;
6438 6439 6440 6441 6442 6443 6444 6445 6446 6447
      if (that->red_sBIT > 8) that->red_sBIT = 8;
      if (that->green_sBIT > 8) that->green_sBIT = 8;
      if (that->blue_sBIT > 8) that->blue_sBIT = 8;
      if (that->alpha_sBIT > 8) that->alpha_sBIT = 8;
   }

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
6448
image_transform_png_set_scale_16_add(image_transform *this,
6449
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
6450
{
6451
   UNUSED(colour_type)
6452 6453 6454 6455 6456 6457 6458

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   return bit_depth > 8;
}

6459
IT(scale_16);
6460
#undef PT
6461
#define PT ITSTRUCT(scale_16)
6462
#endif /* PNG_READ_SCALE_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED (1.5.4 on) */
6463

6464
#ifdef PNG_READ_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED /* the default before 1.5.4 */
6465
/* png_set_strip_16 */
6466
static void
6467
image_transform_png_set_strip_16_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6468 6469
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
6470
   png_set_strip_16(pp);
6471 6472 6473 6474
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
6475
image_transform_png_set_strip_16_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6476 6477
    image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
    PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
6478 6479 6480 6481 6482 6483 6484 6485 6486
{
   if (that->bit_depth == 16)
   {
      that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 8;
      if (that->red_sBIT > 8) that->red_sBIT = 8;
      if (that->green_sBIT > 8) that->green_sBIT = 8;
      if (that->blue_sBIT > 8) that->blue_sBIT = 8;
      if (that->alpha_sBIT > 8) that->alpha_sBIT = 8;

6487 6488 6489
      /* Prior to 1.5.4 png_set_strip_16 would use an 'accurate' method if this
       * configuration option is set.  From 1.5.4 the flag is never set and the
       * 'scale' API (above) must be used.
6490
       */
6491 6492 6493 6494 6495 6496 6497 6498 6499 6500 6501 6502 6503 6504 6505 6506 6507 6508
#     ifdef PNG_READ_ACCURATE_SCALE_SUPPORTED
#        if PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10504
#           error PNG_READ_ACCURATE_SCALE should not be set
#        endif

         /* The strip 16 algorithm drops the low 8 bits rather than calculating
          * 1/257, so we need to adjust the permitted errors appropriately:
          * Notice that this is only relevant prior to the addition of the
          * png_set_scale_16 API in 1.5.4 (but 1.5.4+ always defines the above!)
          */
         {
            PNG_CONST double d = (255-128.5)/65535;
            that->rede += d;
            that->greene += d;
            that->bluee += d;
            that->alphae += d;
         }
#     endif
6509 6510 6511 6512 6513 6514
   }

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
6515
image_transform_png_set_strip_16_add(image_transform *this,
6516 6517 6518 6519 6520 6521 6522 6523 6524 6525
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
{
   UNUSED(colour_type)

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   return bit_depth > 8;
}

6526
IT(strip_16);
6527
#undef PT
6528
#define PT ITSTRUCT(strip_16)
6529
#endif /* PNG_READ_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED */
6530

6531
#ifdef PNG_READ_STRIP_ALPHA_SUPPORTED
6532 6533 6534 6535 6536 6537 6538 6539 6540 6541 6542
/* png_set_strip_alpha */
static void
image_transform_png_set_strip_alpha_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_strip_alpha(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_strip_alpha_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6543 6544
    image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
    PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
6545 6546 6547 6548 6549 6550
{
   if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA)
      that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY;
   else if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA)
      that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;

6551 6552 6553 6554 6555 6556 6557 6558 6559 6560 6561 6562 6563 6564 6565 6566 6567 6568 6569 6570 6571 6572 6573 6574 6575 6576 6577 6578 6579 6580 6581 6582 6583 6584 6585 6586 6587 6588 6589 6590 6591 6592 6593 6594 6595 6596 6597 6598 6599 6600 6601 6602 6603 6604 6605 6606 6607 6608 6609 6610 6611 6612 6613 6614 6615 6616 6617 6618 6619 6620 6621 6622 6623 6624 6625 6626 6627 6628 6629 6630 6631 6632 6633 6634 6635 6636 6637 6638 6639 6640 6641 6642 6643 6644 6645 6646 6647 6648 6649 6650 6651 6652 6653 6654 6655 6656 6657 6658 6659 6660 6661 6662 6663 6664 6665 6666 6667 6668 6669 6670 6671 6672 6673 6674 6675 6676 6677 6678 6679 6680 6681 6682 6683 6684 6685 6686 6687 6688 6689 6690 6691 6692 6693 6694 6695 6696 6697 6698 6699 6700 6701 6702 6703 6704 6705 6706
   that->have_tRNS = 0;
   that->alphaf = 1;

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_strip_alpha_add(image_transform *this,
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
{
   UNUSED(bit_depth)

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0;
}

IT(strip_alpha);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(strip_alpha)
#endif /* PNG_READ_STRIP_ALPHA_SUPPORTED */

#ifdef PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED
/* png_set_rgb_to_gray(png_structp, int err_action, double red, double green)
 * png_set_rgb_to_gray_fixed(png_structp, int err_action, png_fixed_point red,
 *    png_fixed_point green)
 * png_get_rgb_to_gray_status
 *
 * The 'default' test here uses values known to be used inside libpng:
 *
 *   red:    6968
 *   green: 23434
 *   blue:   2366
 *
 * These values are being retained for compatibility, along with the somewhat
 * broken truncation calculation in the fast-and-inaccurate code path.  Older
 * versions of libpng will fail the accuracy tests below because they use the
 * truncation algorithm everywhere.
 */
#define data ITDATA(rgb_to_gray)
static struct
{
   double gamma;      /* File gamma to use in processing */

   /* The following are the parameters for png_set_rgb_to_gray: */
#  ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
      double red_to_set;
      double green_to_set;
#  else
      png_fixed_point red_to_set;
      png_fixed_point green_to_set;
#  endif

   /* The actual coefficients: */
   double red_coefficient;
   double green_coefficient;
   double blue_coefficient;

   /* Set if the coeefficients have been overridden. */
   int coefficients_overridden;
} data;

#undef image_transform_ini
#define image_transform_ini image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_ini
static void
image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_ini(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that)
{
   png_modifier *pm = that->pm;
   PNG_CONST color_encoding *e = pm->current_encoding;

   UNUSED(this)

   /* Since we check the encoding this flag must be set: */
   pm->test_uses_encoding = 1;

   /* If 'e' is not NULL chromaticity information is present and either a cHRM
    * or an sRGB chunk will be inserted.
    */
   if (e != 0)
   {
      /* Coefficients come from the encoding, but may need to be normalized to a
       * white point Y of 1.0
       */
      PNG_CONST double whiteY = e->red.Y + e->green.Y + e->blue.Y;

      data.red_coefficient = e->red.Y;
      data.green_coefficient = e->green.Y;
      data.blue_coefficient = e->blue.Y;

      if (whiteY != 1)
      {
         data.red_coefficient /= whiteY;
         data.green_coefficient /= whiteY;
         data.blue_coefficient /= whiteY;
      }
   }

   else
   {
      /* The default (built in) coeffcients, as above: */
      data.red_coefficient = 6968 / 32768.;
      data.green_coefficient = 23434 / 32768.;
      data.blue_coefficient = 2366 / 32768.;
   }

   data.gamma = pm->current_gamma;

   /* If not set then the calculations assume linear encoding (implicitly): */
   if (data.gamma == 0)
      data.gamma = 1;

   /* The arguments to png_set_rgb_to_gray can override the coefficients implied
    * by the color space encoding.  If doing exhaustive checks do the override
    * in each case, otherwise do it randomly.
    */
   if (pm->test_exhaustive)
   {
      /* First time in coefficients_overridden is 0, the following sets it to 1,
       * so repeat if it is set.  If a test fails this may mean we subsequently
       * skip a non-override test, ignore that.
       */
      data.coefficients_overridden = !data.coefficients_overridden;
      pm->repeat = data.coefficients_overridden != 0;
   }

   else
      data.coefficients_overridden = random_choice();

   if (data.coefficients_overridden)
   {
      /* These values override the color encoding defaults, simply use random
       * numbers.
       */
      png_uint_32 ru;
      double total;

      RANDOMIZE(ru);
      data.green_coefficient = total = (ru & 0xffff) / 65535.;
      ru >>= 16;
      data.red_coefficient = (1 - total) * (ru & 0xffff) / 65535.;
      total += data.red_coefficient;
      data.blue_coefficient = 1 - total;

#     ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
         data.red_to_set = data.red_coefficient;
         data.green_to_set = data.green_coefficient;
#     else
         data.red_to_set = fix(data.red_coefficient);
         data.green_to_set = fix(data.green_coefficient);
#     endif

      /* The following just changes the error messages: */
      pm->encoding_ignored = 1;
   }
6707

6708 6709 6710 6711 6712
   else
   {
      data.red_to_set = -1;
      data.green_to_set = -1;
   }
6713

6714 6715 6716 6717 6718 6719 6720 6721 6722 6723 6724 6725
   /* Adjust the error limit in the png_modifier because of the larger errors
    * produced in the digitization during the gamma handling.
    */
   if (data.gamma != 1) /* Use gamma tables */
   {
      if (that->this.bit_depth == 16 || pm->assume_16_bit_calculations)
      {
         /* The 16 bit case ends up producing a maximum error of about
          * +/-5 in 65535, allow for +/-8 with the given gamma.
          */
         that->pm->limit += pow(8./65535, data.gamma);
      }
6726

6727 6728 6729 6730 6731 6732 6733 6734 6735
      else
      {
         /* Rounding to 8 bits in the linear space causes massive errors which
          * will trigger the error check in transform_range_check.  Fix that
          * here by taking the gamma encoding into account.
          */
         that->pm->limit += pow(1./255, data.gamma);
      }
   }
6736

6737 6738 6739 6740 6741 6742 6743 6744
   else
   {
      /* With no gamma correction a large error comes from the truncation of the
       * calculation in the 8 bit case, allow for that here.
       */
      if (that->this.bit_depth != 16)
         that->pm->limit += 4E-3;
   }
6745 6746 6747 6748 6749 6750 6751 6752 6753
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   PNG_CONST int error_action = 1; /* no error, no defines in png.h */

#  ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
6754
      png_set_rgb_to_gray(pp, error_action, data.red_to_set, data.green_to_set);
6755
#  else
6756 6757
      png_set_rgb_to_gray_fixed(pp, error_action, data.red_to_set,
         data.green_to_set);
6758 6759
#  endif

6760 6761 6762 6763 6764 6765 6766 6767 6768 6769 6770 6771 6772 6773 6774 6775 6776 6777 6778 6779 6780 6781 6782 6783 6784 6785 6786 6787 6788 6789 6790 6791 6792 6793 6794 6795 6796 6797 6798 6799 6800 6801 6802 6803 6804 6805 6806 6807 6808 6809 6810 6811 6812 6813 6814 6815 6816 6817 6818 6819 6820 6821 6822 6823 6824 6825 6826 6827 6828 6829 6830 6831 6832 6833 6834 6835 6836 6837 6838 6839 6840 6841 6842 6843 6844 6845 6846 6847 6848 6849 6850 6851 6852 6853 6854 6855 6856 6857 6858 6859 6860 6861 6862 6863 6864 6865 6866 6867 6868 6869 6870
#  ifdef PNG_READ_cHRM_SUPPORTED
      if (that->pm->current_encoding != 0)
      {
         /* We have an encoding so a cHRM chunk may have been set; if so then
          * check that the libpng APIs give the correct (X,Y,Z) values within
          * some margin of error for the round trip through the chromaticity
          * form.
          */
#        ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
#           define API_function png_get_cHRM_XYZ
#           define API_form "FP"
#           define API_type double
#           define API_cvt(x) (x)
#        else
#           define API_function png_get_cHRM_XYZ_fixed
#           define API_form "fixed"
#           define API_type png_fixed_point
#           define API_cvt(x) ((double)(x)/PNG_FP_1)
#        endif

         API_type rX, gX, bX;
         API_type rY, gY, bY;
         API_type rZ, gZ, bZ;

         if ((API_function(pp, pi, &rX, &rY, &rZ, &gX, &gY, &gZ, &bX, &bY, &bZ)
               & PNG_INFO_cHRM) != 0)
         {
            double maxe;
            PNG_CONST char *el;
            color_encoding e, o;

            /* Expect libpng to return a normalized result, but the original
             * color space encoding may not be normalized.
             */
            modifier_current_encoding(that->pm, &o);
            normalize_color_encoding(&o);

            /* Sanity check the pngvalid code - the coefficients should match
             * the normalized Y values of the encoding unless they were
             * overridden.
             */
            if (data.red_to_set == -1 && data.green_to_set == -1 &&
               (fabs(o.red.Y - data.red_coefficient) > DBL_EPSILON ||
               fabs(o.green.Y - data.green_coefficient) > DBL_EPSILON ||
               fabs(o.blue.Y - data.blue_coefficient) > DBL_EPSILON))
               png_error(pp, "internal pngvalid cHRM coefficient error");

            /* Generate a colour space encoding. */
            e.gamma = o.gamma; /* not used */
            e.red.X = API_cvt(rX);
            e.red.Y = API_cvt(rY);
            e.red.Z = API_cvt(rZ);
            e.green.X = API_cvt(gX);
            e.green.Y = API_cvt(gY);
            e.green.Z = API_cvt(gZ);
            e.blue.X = API_cvt(bX);
            e.blue.Y = API_cvt(bY);
            e.blue.Z = API_cvt(bZ);

            /* This should match the original one from the png_modifier, within
             * the range permitted by the libpng fixed point representation.
             */
            maxe = 0;
            el = "-"; /* Set to element name with error */

#           define CHECK(col,x)\
            {\
               double err = fabs(o.col.x - e.col.x);\
               if (err > maxe)\
               {\
                  maxe = err;\
                  el = #col "(" #x ")";\
               }\
            }

            CHECK(red,X)
            CHECK(red,Y)
            CHECK(red,Z)
            CHECK(green,X)
            CHECK(green,Y)
            CHECK(green,Z)
            CHECK(blue,X)
            CHECK(blue,Y)
            CHECK(blue,Z)

            /* Here in both fixed and floating cases to check the values read
             * from the cHRm chunk.  PNG uses fixed point in the cHRM chunk, so
             * we can't expect better than +/-.5E-5 on the result, allow 1E-5.
             */
            if (maxe >= 1E-5)
            {
               size_t pos = 0;
               char buffer[256];

               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, API_form);
               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " cHRM ");
               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, el);
               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " error: ");
               pos = safecatd(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, maxe, 7);
               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " ");
               /* Print the color space without the gamma value: */
               pos = safecat_color_encoding(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, &o, 0);
               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " -> ");
               pos = safecat_color_encoding(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, &e, 0);

               png_error(pp, buffer);
            }
         }
      }
#  endif /* READ_cHRM */

6871 6872 6873 6874 6875
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6876 6877
    image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
    PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
6878 6879 6880
{
   if ((that->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) != 0)
   {
6881 6882
      double gray, err;

6883
      if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6884
         image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
6885 6886

      /* Image now has RGB channels... */
6887 6888 6889 6890 6891 6892 6893 6894 6895 6896 6897 6898 6899 6900 6901 6902 6903 6904 6905 6906 6907 6908 6909 6910 6911 6912 6913 6914 6915 6916 6917 6918 6919 6920 6921 6922 6923 6924 6925 6926 6927 6928 6929 6930 6931 6932 6933 6934 6935 6936 6937 6938 6939 6940 6941 6942 6943 6944 6945 6946 6947 6948 6949 6950 6951 6952 6953
      {
         PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm = display->pm;
         PNG_CONST unsigned int sample_depth = that->sample_depth;
         int isgray;
         double r, g, b;
         double rlo, rhi, glo, ghi, blo, bhi, graylo, grayhi;

         /* Do this using interval arithmetic, otherwise it is too difficult to
          * handle the errors correctly.
          *
          * To handle the gamma correction work out the upper and lower bounds
          * of the digitized value.  Assume rounding here - normally the values
          * will be identical after this operation if there is only one
          * transform, feel free to delete the png_error checks on this below in
          * the future (this is just me trying to ensure it works!)
          */
         r = rlo = rhi = that->redf;
         rlo -= that->rede;
         rlo = digitize(pm, rlo, sample_depth, 1/*round*/);
         rhi += that->rede;
         rhi = digitize(pm, rhi, sample_depth, 1/*round*/);

         g = glo = ghi = that->greenf;
         glo -= that->greene;
         glo = digitize(pm, glo, sample_depth, 1/*round*/);
         ghi += that->greene;
         ghi = digitize(pm, ghi, sample_depth, 1/*round*/);

         b = blo = bhi = that->bluef;
         blo -= that->bluee;
         blo = digitize(pm, blo, sample_depth, 1/*round*/);
         bhi += that->greene;
         bhi = digitize(pm, bhi, sample_depth, 1/*round*/);

         isgray = r==g && g==b;

         if (data.gamma != 1)
         {
            PNG_CONST double power = 1/data.gamma;
            PNG_CONST double abse = abserr(pm, sample_depth, sample_depth);

            /* 'abse' is the absolute error permitted in linear calculations. It
             * is used here to capture the error permitted in the handling
             * (undoing) of the gamma encoding.  Once again digitization occurs
             * to handle the upper and lower bounds of the values.  This is
             * where the real errors are introduced.
             */
            r = pow(r, power);
            rlo = digitize(pm, pow(rlo, power)-abse, sample_depth, 1);
            rhi = digitize(pm, pow(rhi, power)+abse, sample_depth, 1);

            g = pow(g, power);
            glo = digitize(pm, pow(glo, power)-abse, sample_depth, 1);
            ghi = digitize(pm, pow(ghi, power)+abse, sample_depth, 1);

            b = pow(b, power);
            blo = digitize(pm, pow(blo, power)-abse, sample_depth, 1);
            bhi = digitize(pm, pow(bhi, power)+abse, sample_depth, 1);
         }

         /* Now calculate the actual gray values.  Although the error in the
          * coefficients depends on whether they were specified on the command
          * line (in which case truncation to 15 bits happened) or not (rounding
          * was used) the maxium error in an individual coefficient is always
          * 1/32768, because even in the rounding case the requirement that
          * coefficients add up to 32768 can cause a larger rounding error.
          *
6954
          * The only time when rounding doesn't occur in 1.5.5 and later is when
6955 6956 6957 6958 6959 6960 6961 6962 6963 6964 6965 6966 6967 6968 6969 6970 6971 6972 6973 6974 6975 6976 6977 6978 6979 6980 6981 6982 6983 6984 6985 6986 6987 6988 6989 6990 6991 6992 6993 6994 6995 6996 6997 6998 6999 7000 7001 7002 7003 7004 7005 7006 7007 7008 7009 7010 7011 7012 7013 7014 7015 7016 7017 7018
          * the non-gamma code path is used for less than 16 bit data.
          */
         gray = r * data.red_coefficient + g * data.green_coefficient +
            b * data.blue_coefficient;

         {
            PNG_CONST int do_round = data.gamma != 1 || sample_depth == 16;
            PNG_CONST double ce = 1. / 32768;

            graylo = digitize(pm, rlo * (data.red_coefficient-ce) +
               glo * (data.green_coefficient-ce) +
               blo * (data.blue_coefficient-ce), sample_depth, do_round);
            if (graylo <= 0)
               graylo = 0;

            grayhi = digitize(pm, rhi * (data.red_coefficient+ce) +
               ghi * (data.green_coefficient+ce) +
               bhi * (data.blue_coefficient+ce), sample_depth, do_round);
            if (grayhi >= 1)
               grayhi = 1;
         }

         /* And invert the gamma. */
         if (data.gamma != 1)
         {
            PNG_CONST double power = data.gamma;

            gray = pow(gray, power);
            graylo = digitize(pm, pow(graylo, power), sample_depth, 1);
            grayhi = digitize(pm, pow(grayhi, power), sample_depth, 1);
         }

         /* Now the error can be calculated.
          *
          * If r==g==b because there is no overall gamma correction libpng
          * currently preserves the original value.
          */
         if (isgray)
            err = (that->rede + that->greene + that->bluee)/3;

         else
         {
            err = fabs(grayhi-gray);
            if (fabs(gray - graylo) > err)
               err = fabs(graylo-gray);

            /* Check that this worked: */
            if (err > display->pm->limit)
            {
               size_t pos = 0;
               char buffer[128];

               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, "rgb_to_gray error ");
               pos = safecatd(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, err, 6);
               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " exceeds limit ");
               pos = safecatd(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos,
                  display->pm->limit, 6);
               png_error(pp, buffer);
            }
         }
      }

      that->bluef = that->greenf = that->redf = gray;
      that->bluee = that->greene = that->rede = err;
7019 7020 7021 7022 7023 7024 7025 7026

      /* The sBIT is the minium of the three colour channel sBITs. */
      if (that->red_sBIT > that->green_sBIT)
         that->red_sBIT = that->green_sBIT;
      if (that->red_sBIT > that->blue_sBIT)
         that->red_sBIT = that->blue_sBIT;
      that->blue_sBIT = that->green_sBIT = that->red_sBIT;

7027
      /* And remove the colour bit in the type: */
7028 7029 7030 7031 7032 7033 7034 7035 7036 7037 7038
      if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB)
         that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY;
      else if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA)
         that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA;
   }

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_add(image_transform *this,
7039
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
7040
{
7041
   UNUSED(bit_depth)
7042 7043 7044 7045 7046 7047 7048

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) != 0;
}

7049
#undef data
7050 7051 7052
IT(rgb_to_gray);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(rgb_to_gray)
7053 7054
#undef image_transform_ini
#define image_transform_ini image_transform_default_ini
7055
#endif /* PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED */
7056

7057
#ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
7058 7059 7060 7061 7062 7063
/* png_set_background(png_structp, png_const_color_16p background_color,
 *    int background_gamma_code, int need_expand, double background_gamma)
 * png_set_background_fixed(png_structp, png_const_color_16p background_color,
 *    int background_gamma_code, int need_expand,
 *    png_fixed_point background_gamma)
 *
7064
 * As with rgb_to_gray this ignores the gamma (at present.)
7065
*/
7066 7067 7068
#define data ITDATA(background)
static image_pixel data;

7069 7070 7071 7072
static void
image_transform_png_set_background_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
7073 7074
   png_byte colour_type, bit_depth;
   png_byte random_bytes[8]; /* 8 bytes - 64 bits - the biggest pixel */
7075 7076
   png_color_16 back;

7077 7078 7079 7080 7081 7082 7083 7084 7085
   /* We need a background colour, because we don't know exactly what transforms
    * have been set we have to supply the colour in the original file format and
    * so we need to know what that is!  The background colour is stored in the
    * transform_display.
    */
   RANDOMIZE(random_bytes);

   /* Read the random value, for colour type 3 the background colour is actually
    * expressed as a 24bit rgb, not an index.
7086
    */
7087 7088 7089 7090 7091 7092 7093 7094 7095 7096
   colour_type = that->this.colour_type;
   if (colour_type == 3)
   {
      colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;
      bit_depth = 8;
   }

   else
      bit_depth = that->this.bit_depth;

7097
   image_pixel_init(&data, random_bytes, colour_type,
7098
      bit_depth, 0/*x*/, 0/*unused: palette*/);
7099

7100 7101 7102 7103 7104 7105 7106
   /* Extract the background colour from this image_pixel, but make sure the
    * unused fields of 'back' are garbage.
    */
   RANDOMIZE(back);

   if (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR)
   {
7107 7108 7109
      back.red = (png_uint_16)data.red;
      back.green = (png_uint_16)data.green;
      back.blue = (png_uint_16)data.blue;
7110 7111 7112
   }

   else
7113
      back.gray = (png_uint_16)data.red;
7114

7115
#  ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
7116 7117
      png_set_background(pp, &back, PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE, 1/*need expand*/,
         0);
7118
#  else
7119 7120
      png_set_background_fixed(pp, &back, PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE,
         1/*need expand*/, 0);
7121 7122 7123 7124 7125 7126 7127
#  endif

   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_background_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
7128 7129
    image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
    PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
7130
{
7131 7132
   /* Check for tRNS first: */
   if (that->have_tRNS && that->colour_type != PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
7133 7134
      image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this);

7135 7136
   /* This is only necessary if the alpha value is less than 1. */
   if (that->alphaf < 1)
7137
   {
7138
      /* Now we do the background calculation without any gamma correction. */
7139 7140
      if (that->alphaf <= 0)
      {
7141 7142 7143
         that->redf = data.redf;
         that->greenf = data.greenf;
         that->bluef = data.bluef;
7144

7145 7146 7147
         that->rede = data.rede;
         that->greene = data.greene;
         that->bluee = data.bluee;
7148

7149 7150 7151
         that->red_sBIT= data.red_sBIT;
         that->green_sBIT= data.green_sBIT;
         that->blue_sBIT= data.blue_sBIT;
7152 7153
      }

7154
      else /* 0 < alpha < 1 */
7155
      {
7156 7157
         double alf = 1 - that->alphaf;

7158 7159
         that->redf = that->redf * that->alphaf + data.redf * alf;
         that->rede = that->rede * that->alphaf + data.rede * alf +
7160
            DBL_EPSILON;
7161 7162
         that->greenf = that->greenf * that->alphaf + data.greenf * alf;
         that->greene = that->greene * that->alphaf + data.greene * alf +
7163
            DBL_EPSILON;
7164 7165
         that->bluef = that->bluef * that->alphaf + data.bluef * alf;
         that->bluee = that->bluee * that->alphaf + data.bluee * alf +
7166 7167 7168
            DBL_EPSILON;
      }

7169
      /* Remove the alpha type and set the alpha (not in that order.) */
7170 7171 7172 7173 7174 7175 7176
      that->alphaf = 1;
      that->alphae = 0;

      if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA)
         that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;
      else if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA)
         that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY;
7177
      /* PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE is not changed */
7178 7179
   }

7180 7181 7182 7183 7184
   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

#define image_transform_png_set_background_add image_transform_default_add

7185
#undef data
7186 7187 7188 7189
IT(background);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(background)
#endif /* PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED */
7190

7191 7192
/* This may just be 'end' if all the transforms are disabled! */
static image_transform *PNG_CONST image_transform_first = &PT;
7193 7194 7195 7196 7197 7198 7199 7200 7201 7202 7203 7204

static void
transform_enable(PNG_CONST char *name)
{
   /* Everything starts out enabled, so if we see an 'enable' disabled
    * everything else the first time round.
    */
   static int all_disabled = 0;
   int found_it = 0;
   image_transform *list = image_transform_first;

   while (list != &image_transform_end)
7205
   {
7206 7207 7208 7209 7210 7211 7212 7213 7214
      if (strcmp(list->name, name) == 0)
      {
         list->enable = 1;
         found_it = 1;
      }
      else if (!all_disabled)
         list->enable = 0;

      list = list->list;
7215 7216
   }

7217 7218 7219 7220 7221 7222
   all_disabled = 1;

   if (!found_it)
   {
      fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: --transform-enable=%s: unknown transform\n",
         name);
7223
      exit(99);
7224
   }
7225 7226
}

7227 7228
static void
transform_disable(PNG_CONST char *name)
7229
{
7230
   image_transform *list = image_transform_first;
7231

7232 7233 7234 7235 7236 7237 7238
   while (list != &image_transform_end)
   {
      if (strcmp(list->name, name) == 0)
      {
         list->enable = 0;
         return;
      }
7239

7240 7241
      list = list->list;
   }
7242

7243 7244
   fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: --transform-disable=%s: unknown transform\n",
      name);
7245
   exit(99);
7246 7247
}

7248 7249 7250 7251 7252
static void
image_transform_reset_count(void)
{
   image_transform *next = image_transform_first;
   int count = 0;
7253

7254 7255 7256 7257 7258 7259 7260
   while (next != &image_transform_end)
   {
      next->local_use = 0;
      next->next = 0;
      next = next->list;
      ++count;
   }
7261

7262 7263 7264 7265 7266 7267 7268 7269
   /* This can only happen if we every have more than 32 transforms (excluding
    * the end) in the list.
    */
   if (count > 32) abort();
}

static int
image_transform_test_counter(png_uint_32 counter, unsigned int max)
7270
{
7271 7272 7273 7274 7275 7276 7277 7278 7279 7280 7281 7282 7283 7284 7285 7286 7287 7288
   /* Test the list to see if there is any point contining, given a current
    * counter and a 'max' value.
    */
   image_transform *next = image_transform_first;

   while (next != &image_transform_end)
   {
      /* For max 0 or 1 continue until the counter overflows: */
      counter >>= 1;

      /* Continue if any entry hasn't reacked the max. */
      if (max > 1 && next->local_use < max)
         return 1;
      next = next->list;
   }

   return max <= 1 && counter == 0;
}
7289 7290

static png_uint_32
7291
image_transform_add(PNG_CONST image_transform **this, unsigned int max,
7292 7293 7294
   png_uint_32 counter, char *name, size_t sizeof_name, size_t *pos,
   png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
{
7295
   for (;;) /* until we manage to add something */
7296
   {
7297 7298
      png_uint_32 mask;
      image_transform *list;
7299

7300 7301 7302 7303 7304 7305 7306 7307 7308 7309 7310 7311 7312
      /* Find the next counter value, if the counter is zero this is the start
       * of the list.  This routine always returns the current counter (not the
       * next) so it returns 0 at the end and expects 0 at the beginning.
       */
      if (counter == 0) /* first time */
      {
         image_transform_reset_count();
         if (max <= 1)
            counter = 1;
         else
            counter = random_32();
      }
      else /* advance the counter */
7313
      {
7314 7315 7316 7317 7318 7319 7320
         switch (max)
         {
            case 0:  ++counter; break;
            case 1:  counter <<= 1; break;
            default: counter = random_32(); break;
         }
      }
7321

7322 7323 7324 7325
      /* Now add all these items, if possible */
      *this = &image_transform_end;
      list = image_transform_first;
      mask = 1;
7326

7327 7328 7329 7330 7331
      /* Go through the whole list adding anything that the counter selects: */
      while (list != &image_transform_end)
      {
         if ((counter & mask) != 0 && list->enable &&
             (max == 0 || list->local_use < max))
7332
         {
7333 7334
            /* Candidate to add: */
            if (list->add(list, this, colour_type, bit_depth) || max == 0)
7335
            {
7336 7337 7338
               /* Added, so add to the name too. */
               *pos = safecat(name, sizeof_name, *pos, " +");
               *pos = safecat(name, sizeof_name, *pos, list->name);
7339 7340
            }

7341
            else
7342
            {
7343
               /* Not useful and max>0, so remove it from *this: */
7344 7345
               *this = list->next;
               list->next = 0;
7346

7347 7348 7349 7350 7351
               /* And, since we know it isn't useful, stop it being added again
                * in this run:
                */
               list->local_use = max;
            }
7352 7353
         }

7354 7355 7356
         mask <<= 1;
         list = list->list;
      }
7357

7358 7359 7360
      /* Now if anything was added we have something to do. */
      if (*this != &image_transform_end)
         return counter;
7361

7362 7363 7364
      /* Nothing added, but was there anything in there to add? */
      if (!image_transform_test_counter(counter, max))
         return 0;
7365 7366 7367 7368 7369 7370 7371 7372 7373 7374 7375 7376 7377 7378
   }
}

#ifdef THIS_IS_THE_PROFORMA
static void
image_transform_png_set_@_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_@(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_@_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
7379 7380
    image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
    PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
7381 7382 7383 7384 7385 7386 7387 7388 7389 7390 7391 7392 7393 7394 7395 7396 7397 7398 7399 7400 7401 7402 7403 7404 7405 7406 7407 7408 7409 7410 7411 7412 7413 7414 7415 7416 7417 7418 7419 7420 7421 7422 7423 7424 7425 7426 7427 7428 7429 7430 7431 7432 7433 7434 7435 7436 7437 7438 7439 7440 7441 7442 7443 7444
{
   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_@_add(image_transform *this,
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, char *name, size_t sizeof_name,
    size_t *pos, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
{
   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   *pos = safecat(name, sizeof_name, *pos, " +@");

   return 1;
}

IT(@);
#endif

/* png_set_quantize(png_structp, png_colorp palette, int num_palette,
 *    int maximum_colors, png_const_uint_16p histogram, int full_quantize)
 *
 * Very difficult to validate this!
 */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* The data layout transforms are handled by swapping our own channel data,
 * necessarily these need to happen at the end of the transform list because the
 * semantic of the channels changes after these are executed.  Some of these,
 * like set_shift and set_packing, can't be done at present because they change
 * the layout of the data at the sub-sample level so sample() won't get the
 * right answer.
 */
/* png_set_invert_alpha */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_bgr */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_swap_alpha */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_swap */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_filler, (png_structp png_ptr, png_uint_32 filler, int flags)); */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_add_alpha, (png_structp png_ptr, png_uint_32 filler, int flags)); */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_packing */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_packswap */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_invert_mono */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_shift(png_structp, png_const_color_8p true_bits) */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

7445 7446
static void
perform_transform_test(png_modifier *pm)
7447
{
7448 7449
   png_byte colour_type = 0;
   png_byte bit_depth = 0;
7450
   unsigned int palette_number = 0;
7451 7452

   while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number))
7453
   {
7454
      png_uint_32 counter = 0;
7455 7456 7457 7458 7459 7460 7461 7462 7463 7464
      size_t base_pos;
      char name[64];

      base_pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, 0, "transform:");

      for (;;)
      {
         size_t pos = base_pos;
         PNG_CONST image_transform *list = 0;

7465
         /* 'max' is currently hardwired to '1'; this should be settable on the
7466 7467 7468 7469
          * command line.
          */
         counter = image_transform_add(&list, 1/*max*/, counter,
            name, sizeof name, &pos, colour_type, bit_depth);
7470 7471 7472 7473 7474

         if (counter == 0)
            break;

         /* The command line can change this to checking interlaced images. */
7475 7476 7477 7478 7479
         do
         {
            pm->repeat = 0;
            transform_test(pm, FILEID(colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
               pm->interlace_type, 0, 0, 0), list, name);
7480

7481 7482 7483 7484
            if (fail(pm))
               return;
         }
         while (pm->repeat);
7485 7486 7487
      }
   }
}
7488
#endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
7489 7490

/********************************* GAMMA TESTS ********************************/
7491
#ifdef PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED
7492 7493 7494 7495 7496 7497 7498 7499 7500 7501 7502
/* Reader callbacks and implementations, where they differ from the standard
 * ones.
 */
typedef struct gamma_display
{
   standard_display this;

   /* Parameters */
   png_modifier*    pm;
   double           file_gamma;
   double           screen_gamma;
7503
   double           background_gamma;
7504 7505 7506
   png_byte         sbit;
   int              threshold_test;
   int              use_input_precision;
7507
   int              scale16;
7508 7509 7510
   int              expand16;
   int              do_background;
   png_color_16     background_color;
7511 7512 7513 7514 7515 7516 7517

   /* Local variables */
   double       maxerrout;
   double       maxerrpc;
   double       maxerrabs;
} gamma_display;

7518 7519
#define ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET 4

7520 7521 7522
static void
gamma_display_init(gamma_display *dp, png_modifier *pm, png_uint_32 id,
    double file_gamma, double screen_gamma, png_byte sbit, int threshold_test,
7523
    int use_input_precision, int scale16, int expand16,
7524 7525
    int do_background, PNG_CONST png_color_16 *pointer_to_the_background_color,
    double background_gamma)
7526 7527
{
   /* Standard fields */
7528
   standard_display_init(&dp->this, &pm->this, id, 0/*do_interlace*/,
7529
      pm->use_update_info);
7530 7531 7532 7533 7534

   /* Parameter fields */
   dp->pm = pm;
   dp->file_gamma = file_gamma;
   dp->screen_gamma = screen_gamma;
7535
   dp->background_gamma = background_gamma;
7536 7537
   dp->sbit = sbit;
   dp->threshold_test = threshold_test;
7538
   dp->use_input_precision = use_input_precision;
7539
   dp->scale16 = scale16;
7540 7541 7542 7543 7544 7545
   dp->expand16 = expand16;
   dp->do_background = do_background;
   if (do_background && pointer_to_the_background_color != 0)
      dp->background_color = *pointer_to_the_background_color;
   else
      memset(&dp->background_color, 0, sizeof dp->background_color);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
7546

7547 7548 7549
   /* Local variable fields */
   dp->maxerrout = dp->maxerrpc = dp->maxerrabs = 0;
}
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
7550

7551 7552 7553
static void
gamma_info_imp(gamma_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
7554
   /* Reuse the standard stuff as appropriate. */
7555
   standard_info_part1(&dp->this, pp, pi);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
7556

7557 7558 7559 7560 7561
   /* If requested strip 16 to 8 bits - this is handled automagically below
    * because the output bit depth is read from the library.  Note that there
    * are interactions with sBIT but, internally, libpng makes sbit at most
    * PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8 when doing the following.
    */
7562
   if (dp->scale16)
7563
#     ifdef PNG_READ_SCALE_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED
7564
         png_set_scale_16(pp);
7565
#     else
7566 7567 7568 7569 7570 7571
         /* The following works both in 1.5.4 and earlier versions: */
#        ifdef PNG_READ_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED
            png_set_strip_16(pp);
#        else
            png_error(pp, "scale16 (16 to 8 bit conversion) not supported");
#        endif
7572
#     endif
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
7573

7574 7575 7576 7577 7578 7579 7580 7581 7582 7583 7584 7585 7586 7587 7588 7589 7590 7591 7592 7593
   if (dp->expand16)
#     ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_16_SUPPORTED
         png_set_expand_16(pp);
#     else
         png_error(pp, "expand16 (8 to 16 bit conversion) not supported");
#     endif

   if (dp->do_background >= ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET)
   {
#     ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
      {
         /* This tests the alpha mode handling, if supported. */
         int mode = dp->do_background - ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET;

         /* The gamma value is the output gamma, and is in the standard,
          * non-inverted, represenation.  It provides a default for the PNG file
          * gamma, but since the file has a gAMA chunk this does not matter.
          */
         PNG_CONST double sg = dp->screen_gamma;
#        ifndef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
7594
            PNG_CONST png_fixed_point g = fix(sg);
7595 7596 7597 7598 7599 7600 7601 7602 7603 7604 7605 7606 7607 7608 7609 7610 7611
#        endif

#        ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
            png_set_alpha_mode(pp, mode, sg);
#        else
            png_set_alpha_mode_fixed(pp, mode, g);
#        endif

         /* However, for the standard Porter-Duff algorithm the output defaults
          * to be linear, so if the test requires non-linear output it must be
          * corrected here.
          */
         if (mode == PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD && sg != 1)
         {
#           ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
               png_set_gamma(pp, sg, dp->file_gamma);
#           else
7612
               png_fixed_point f = fix(dp->file_gamma);
7613 7614 7615 7616 7617 7618 7619 7620 7621 7622 7623 7624 7625 7626 7627 7628
               png_set_gamma_fixed(pp, g, f);
#           endif
         }
      }
#     else
         png_error(pp, "alpha mode handling not supported");
#     endif
   }

   else
   {
      /* Set up gamma processing. */
#     ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
         png_set_gamma(pp, dp->screen_gamma, dp->file_gamma);
#     else
      {
7629 7630
         png_fixed_point s = fix(dp->screen_gamma);
         png_fixed_point f = fix(dp->file_gamma);
7631 7632 7633 7634 7635 7636 7637 7638 7639 7640 7641
         png_set_gamma_fixed(pp, s, f);
      }
#     endif

      if (dp->do_background)
      {
#     ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
         /* NOTE: this assumes the caller provided the correct background gamma!
          */
         PNG_CONST double bg = dp->background_gamma;
#        ifndef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
7642
            PNG_CONST png_fixed_point g = fix(bg);
7643 7644 7645 7646 7647 7648 7649 7650 7651 7652 7653 7654 7655 7656 7657
#        endif

#        ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
            png_set_background(pp, &dp->background_color, dp->do_background,
               0/*need_expand*/, bg);
#        else
            png_set_background_fixed(pp, &dp->background_color,
               dp->do_background, 0/*need_expand*/, g);
#        endif
#     else
         png_error(pp, "png_set_background not supported");
#     endif
      }
   }

7658 7659 7660 7661 7662 7663 7664
   {
      int i = dp->this.use_update_info;
      /* Always do one call, even if use_update_info is 0. */
      do
         png_read_update_info(pp, pi);
      while (--i > 0);
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
7665

7666
   /* Now we may get a different cbRow: */
7667
   standard_info_part2(&dp->this, pp, pi, 1 /*images*/);
7668 7669 7670 7671 7672
}

static void
gamma_info(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
7673 7674
   gamma_info_imp(voidcast(gamma_display*, png_get_progressive_ptr(pp)), pp,
      pi);
7675
}
7676

7677 7678 7679 7680 7681 7682
/* Validate a single component value - the routine gets the input and output
 * sample values as unscaled PNG component values along with a cache of all the
 * information required to validate the values.
 */
typedef struct validate_info
{
7683
   png_const_structp  pp;
7684 7685 7686 7687
   gamma_display *dp;
   png_byte sbit;
   int use_input_precision;
   int do_background;
7688
   int scale16;
7689 7690 7691 7692 7693 7694 7695 7696 7697 7698 7699 7700 7701 7702
   unsigned int sbit_max;
   unsigned int isbit_shift;
   unsigned int outmax;

   double gamma_correction; /* Overall correction required. */
   double file_inverse;     /* Inverse of file gamma. */
   double screen_gamma;
   double screen_inverse;   /* Inverse of screen gamma. */

   double background_red;   /* Linear background value, red or gray. */
   double background_green;
   double background_blue;

   double maxabs;
7703
   double maxpc;
7704 7705
   double maxcalc;
   double maxout;
7706
   double maxout_total;     /* Total including quantization error */
7707
   double outlog;
7708
   int    outquant;
7709 7710 7711 7712
}
validate_info;

static void
7713
init_validate_info(validate_info *vi, gamma_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
7714
    int in_depth, int out_depth)
7715
{
7716
   PNG_CONST unsigned int outmax = (1U<<out_depth)-1;
7717 7718 7719

   vi->pp = pp;
   vi->dp = dp;
7720 7721 7722 7723 7724 7725 7726 7727 7728 7729 7730 7731 7732 7733

   if (dp->sbit > 0 && dp->sbit < in_depth)
   {
      vi->sbit = dp->sbit;
      vi->isbit_shift = in_depth - dp->sbit;
   }

   else
   {
      vi->sbit = (png_byte)in_depth;
      vi->isbit_shift = 0;
   }

   vi->sbit_max = (1U << vi->sbit)-1;
7734 7735 7736 7737 7738 7739 7740 7741 7742 7743 7744 7745

   /* This mimics the libpng threshold test, '0' is used to prevent gamma
    * correction in the validation test.
    */
   vi->screen_gamma = dp->screen_gamma;
   if (fabs(vi->screen_gamma-1) < PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
      vi->screen_gamma = vi->screen_inverse = 0;
   else
      vi->screen_inverse = 1/vi->screen_gamma;

   vi->use_input_precision = dp->use_input_precision;
   vi->outmax = outmax;
7746 7747 7748 7749 7750 7751
   vi->maxabs = abserr(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
   vi->maxpc = pcerr(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
   vi->maxcalc = calcerr(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
   vi->maxout = outerr(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
   vi->outquant = output_quantization_factor(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
   vi->maxout_total = vi->maxout + vi->outquant * .5;
7752
   vi->outlog = outlog(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
7753

7754 7755
   if ((dp->this.colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0 ||
      (dp->this.colour_type == 3 && dp->this.is_transparent))
7756 7757 7758 7759 7760 7761 7762 7763 7764 7765 7766 7767 7768 7769 7770 7771 7772 7773 7774 7775 7776 7777 7778 7779 7780 7781 7782 7783 7784 7785 7786 7787 7788 7789 7790 7791 7792 7793 7794 7795 7796 7797 7798
   {
      vi->do_background = dp->do_background;

      if (vi->do_background != 0)
      {
         PNG_CONST double bg_inverse = 1/dp->background_gamma;
         double r, g, b;

         /* Caller must at least put the gray value into the red channel */
         r = dp->background_color.red; r /= outmax;
         g = dp->background_color.green; g /= outmax;
         b = dp->background_color.blue; b /= outmax;

#     if 0
         /* libpng doesn't do this optimization, if we do pngvalid will fail.
          */
         if (fabs(bg_inverse-1) >= PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
#     endif
         {
            r = pow(r, bg_inverse);
            g = pow(g, bg_inverse);
            b = pow(b, bg_inverse);
         }

         vi->background_red = r;
         vi->background_green = g;
         vi->background_blue = b;
      }
   }
   else
      vi->do_background = 0;

   if (vi->do_background == 0)
      vi->background_red = vi->background_green = vi->background_blue = 0;

   vi->gamma_correction = 1/(dp->file_gamma*dp->screen_gamma);
   if (fabs(vi->gamma_correction-1) < PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
      vi->gamma_correction = 0;

   vi->file_inverse = 1/dp->file_gamma;
   if (fabs(vi->file_inverse-1) < PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
      vi->file_inverse = 0;

7799
   vi->scale16 = dp->scale16;
7800 7801
}

7802 7803 7804 7805 7806 7807 7808 7809 7810 7811 7812
/* This function handles composition of a single non-alpha component.  The
 * argument is the input sample value, in the range 0..1, and the alpha value.
 * The result is the composed, linear, input sample.  If alpha is less than zero
 * this is the alpha component and the function should not be called!
 */
static double
gamma_component_compose(int do_background, double input_sample, double alpha,
   double background, int *compose)
{
   switch (do_background)
   {
7813
#ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
7814 7815 7816 7817 7818 7819 7820 7821 7822 7823 7824 7825 7826 7827 7828 7829 7830
      case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_SCREEN:
      case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE:
      case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_UNIQUE:
         /* Standard PNG background processing. */
         if (alpha < 1)
         {
            if (alpha > 0)
            {
               input_sample = input_sample * alpha + background * (1-alpha);
               if (compose != NULL)
                  *compose = 1;
            }

            else
               input_sample = background;
         }
         break;
7831
#endif
7832 7833 7834 7835 7836 7837 7838 7839 7840 7841 7842 7843 7844 7845 7846 7847 7848 7849 7850 7851 7852 7853 7854 7855 7856 7857 7858 7859 7860 7861 7862 7863

#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD:
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN:
         /* The components are premultiplied in either case and the output is
          * gamma encoded (to get standard Porter-Duff we expect the output
          * gamma to be set to 1.0!)
          */
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED:
         /* The optimization is that the partial-alpha entries are linear
          * while the opaque pixels are gamma encoded, but this only affects the
          * output encoding.
          */
         if (alpha < 1)
         {
            if (alpha > 0)
            {
               input_sample *= alpha;
               if (compose != NULL)
                  *compose = 1;
            }

            else
               input_sample = 0;
         }
         break;
#endif

      default:
         /* Standard cases where no compositing is done (so the component
          * value is already correct.)
          */
7864 7865 7866
         UNUSED(alpha)
         UNUSED(background)
         UNUSED(compose)
7867 7868 7869 7870 7871 7872
         break;
   }

   return input_sample;
}

7873 7874 7875 7876 7877 7878 7879 7880 7881 7882 7883 7884 7885 7886 7887 7888 7889 7890 7891 7892 7893 7894 7895 7896 7897 7898 7899 7900 7901 7902 7903 7904 7905 7906 7907 7908 7909 7910 7911 7912 7913 7914 7915 7916 7917 7918 7919 7920 7921 7922 7923 7924 7925
/* This API returns the encoded *input* component, in the range 0..1 */
static double
gamma_component_validate(PNG_CONST char *name, PNG_CONST validate_info *vi,
    PNG_CONST unsigned int id, PNG_CONST unsigned int od,
    PNG_CONST double alpha /* <0 for the alpha channel itself */,
    PNG_CONST double background /* component background value */)
{
   PNG_CONST unsigned int isbit = id >> vi->isbit_shift;
   PNG_CONST unsigned int sbit_max = vi->sbit_max;
   PNG_CONST unsigned int outmax = vi->outmax;
   PNG_CONST int do_background = vi->do_background;

   double i;

   /* First check on the 'perfect' result obtained from the digitized input
    * value, id, and compare this against the actual digitized result, 'od'.
    * 'i' is the input result in the range 0..1:
    */
   i = isbit; i /= sbit_max;

   /* Check for the fast route: if we don't do any background composition or if
    * this is the alpha channel ('alpha' < 0) or if the pixel is opaque then
    * just use the gamma_correction field to correct to the final output gamma.
    */
   if (alpha == 1 /* opaque pixel component */ || !do_background
#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
      || do_background == ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_PNG
#endif
      || (alpha < 0 /* alpha channel */
#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
      && do_background != ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN
#endif
      ))
   {
      /* Then get the gamma corrected version of 'i' and compare to 'od', any
       * error less than .5 is insignificant - just quantization of the output
       * value to the nearest digital value (nevertheless the error is still
       * recorded - it's interesting ;-)
       */
      double encoded_sample = i;
      double encoded_error;

      /* alpha less than 0 indicates the alpha channel, which is always linear
       */
      if (alpha >= 0 && vi->gamma_correction > 0)
         encoded_sample = pow(encoded_sample, vi->gamma_correction);
      encoded_sample *= outmax;

      encoded_error = fabs(od-encoded_sample);

      if (encoded_error > vi->dp->maxerrout)
         vi->dp->maxerrout = encoded_error;

7926
      if (encoded_error < vi->maxout_total && encoded_error < vi->outlog)
7927 7928 7929 7930 7931 7932 7933 7934 7935 7936 7937 7938 7939
         return i;
   }

   /* The slow route - attempt to do linear calculations. */
   /* There may be an error, or background processing is required, so calculate
    * the actual sample values - unencoded light intensity values.  Note that in
    * practice these are not completely unencoded because they include a
    * 'viewing correction' to decrease or (normally) increase the perceptual
    * contrast of the image.  There's nothing we can do about this - we don't
    * know what it is - so assume the unencoded value is perceptually linear.
    */
   {
      double input_sample = i; /* In range 0..1 */
7940
      double output, error, encoded_sample, encoded_error;
7941
      double es_lo, es_hi;
7942 7943
      int compose = 0;           /* Set to one if composition done */
      int output_is_encoded;     /* Set if encoded to screen gamma */
7944
      int log_max_error = 1;     /* Check maximum error values */
7945
      png_const_charp pass = 0;  /* Reason test passes (or 0 for fail) */
7946 7947 7948 7949

      /* Convert to linear light (with the above caveat.)  The alpha channel is
       * already linear.
       */
7950 7951 7952 7953
      if (alpha >= 0)
      {
         int tcompose;

7954
         if (vi->file_inverse > 0)
7955 7956 7957 7958 7959 7960 7961 7962 7963 7964
            input_sample = pow(input_sample, vi->file_inverse);

         /* Handle the compose processing: */
         tcompose = 0;
         input_sample = gamma_component_compose(do_background, input_sample,
            alpha, background, &tcompose);

         if (tcompose)
            compose = 1;
      }
7965 7966

      /* And similarly for the output value, but we need to check the background
7967
       * handling to linearize it correctly.
7968 7969 7970 7971
       */
      output = od;
      output /= outmax;

7972
      output_is_encoded = vi->screen_gamma > 0;
7973

7974 7975
      if (alpha < 0) /* The alpha channel */
      {
7976
#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
7977
         if (do_background != ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN)
7978
#endif
7979
         {
7980 7981 7982
            /* In all other cases the output alpha channel is linear already,
             * don't log errors here, they are much larger in linear data.
             */
7983
            output_is_encoded = 0;
7984
            log_max_error = 0;
7985
         }
7986 7987
      }

7988
#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
7989
      else /* A component */
7990
      {
7991 7992 7993 7994 7995 7996
         if (do_background == ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED &&
            alpha < 1) /* the optimized case - linear output */
         {
            if (alpha > 0) log_max_error = 0;
            output_is_encoded = 0;
         }
7997
      }
7998
#endif
7999

8000 8001 8002
      if (output_is_encoded)
         output = pow(output, vi->screen_gamma);

8003 8004 8005 8006 8007 8008 8009 8010
      /* Calculate (or recalculate) the encoded_sample value and repeat the
       * check above (unnecessary if we took the fast route, but harmless.)
       */
      encoded_sample = input_sample;
      if (output_is_encoded)
         encoded_sample = pow(encoded_sample, vi->screen_inverse);
      encoded_sample *= outmax;

8011
      encoded_error = fabs(od-encoded_sample);
8012

8013 8014 8015 8016 8017
      /* Don't log errors in the alpha channel, or the 'optimized' case,
       * neither are significant to the overall perception.
       */
      if (log_max_error && encoded_error > vi->dp->maxerrout)
         vi->dp->maxerrout = encoded_error;
8018

8019 8020 8021
      if (encoded_error < vi->maxout_total)
      {
         if (encoded_error < vi->outlog)
8022
            return i;
8023 8024 8025 8026 8027

         /* Test passed but error is bigger than the log limit, record why the
          * test passed:
          */
         pass = "less than maxout:\n";
8028 8029
      }

8030 8031 8032 8033 8034 8035 8036 8037 8038 8039 8040
      /* i: the original input value in the range 0..1
       *
       * pngvalid calculations:
       *  input_sample: linear result; i linearized and composed, range 0..1
       *  encoded_sample: encoded result; input_sample scaled to ouput bit depth
       *
       * libpng calculations:
       *  output: linear result; od scaled to 0..1 and linearized
       *  od: encoded result from libpng
       */

8041 8042 8043 8044 8045 8046 8047 8048 8049
      /* Now we have the numbers for real errors, both absolute values as as a
       * percentage of the correct value (output):
       */
      error = fabs(input_sample-output);

      if (log_max_error && error > vi->dp->maxerrabs)
         vi->dp->maxerrabs = error;

      /* The following is an attempt to ignore the tendency of quantization to
8050
       * dominate the percentage errors for lower result values:
8051
       */
8052
      if (log_max_error && input_sample > .5)
8053 8054 8055 8056 8057 8058 8059 8060 8061 8062 8063 8064 8065 8066 8067
      {
         double percentage_error = error/input_sample;
         if (percentage_error > vi->dp->maxerrpc)
            vi->dp->maxerrpc = percentage_error;
      }

      /* Now calculate the digitization limits for 'encoded_sample' using the
       * 'max' values.  Note that maxout is in the encoded space but maxpc and
       * maxabs are in linear light space.
       *
       * First find the maximum error in linear light space, range 0..1:
       */
      {
         double tmp = input_sample * vi->maxpc;
         if (tmp < vi->maxabs) tmp = vi->maxabs;
8068 8069 8070 8071 8072 8073
         /* If 'compose' is true the composition was done in linear space using
          * integer arithmetic.  This introduces an extra error of +/- 0.5 (at
          * least) in the integer space used.  'maxcalc' records this, taking
          * into account the possibility that even for 16 bit output 8 bit space
          * may have been used.
          */
8074 8075
         if (compose && tmp < vi->maxcalc) tmp = vi->maxcalc;

8076 8077 8078
         /* The 'maxout' value refers to the encoded result, to compare with
          * this encode input_sample adjusted by the maximum error (tmp) above.
          */
8079 8080 8081 8082 8083 8084 8085 8086 8087
         es_lo = encoded_sample - vi->maxout;

         if (es_lo > 0 && input_sample-tmp > 0)
         {
            double low_value = input_sample-tmp;
            if (output_is_encoded)
               low_value = pow(low_value, vi->screen_inverse);
            low_value *= outmax;
            if (low_value < es_lo) es_lo = low_value;
8088 8089 8090

            /* Quantize this appropriately: */
            es_lo = ceil(es_lo / vi->outquant - .5) * vi->outquant;
8091 8092 8093 8094 8095 8096 8097 8098 8099 8100 8101 8102 8103 8104
         }

         else
            es_lo = 0;

         es_hi = encoded_sample + vi->maxout;

         if (es_hi < outmax && input_sample+tmp < 1)
         {
            double high_value = input_sample+tmp;
            if (output_is_encoded)
               high_value = pow(high_value, vi->screen_inverse);
            high_value *= outmax;
            if (high_value > es_hi) es_hi = high_value;
8105 8106

            es_hi = floor(es_hi / vi->outquant + .5) * vi->outquant;
8107 8108 8109 8110 8111 8112 8113 8114
         }

         else
            es_hi = outmax;
      }

      /* The primary test is that the final encoded value returned by the
       * library should be between the two limits (inclusive) that were
8115
       * calculated above.
8116
       */
8117 8118 8119 8120 8121 8122 8123 8124 8125 8126
      if (od >= es_lo && od <= es_hi)
      {
         /* The value passes, but we may need to log the information anyway. */
         if (encoded_error < vi->outlog)
            return i;

         if (pass == 0)
            pass = "within digitization limits:\n";
      }

8127
      {
8128 8129 8130
         /* There has been an error in processing, or we need to log this
          * value.
          */
8131 8132
         double is_lo, is_hi;

8133 8134 8135 8136 8137
         /* pass is set at this point if either of the tests above would have
          * passed.  Don't do these additional tests here - just log the
          * original [es_lo..es_hi] values.
          */
         if (pass == 0 && vi->use_input_precision)
8138 8139
         {
            /* Ok, something is wrong - this actually happens in current libpng
8140 8141
             * 16-to-8 processing.  Assume that the input value (id, adjusted
             * for sbit) can be anywhere between value-.5 and value+.5 - quite a
8142 8143 8144 8145
             * large range if sbit is low.
             */
            double tmp = (isbit - .5)/sbit_max;

8146 8147
            if (tmp <= 0)
               tmp = 0;
8148

8149 8150 8151 8152 8153 8154 8155 8156 8157 8158 8159 8160
            else if (alpha >= 0 && vi->file_inverse > 0 && tmp < 1)
               tmp = pow(tmp, vi->file_inverse);

            tmp = gamma_component_compose(do_background, tmp, alpha, background,
               NULL);

            if (output_is_encoded && tmp > 0 && tmp < 1)
               tmp = pow(tmp, vi->screen_inverse);

            is_lo = ceil(outmax * tmp - vi->maxout_total);

            if (is_lo < 0)
8161 8162 8163 8164
               is_lo = 0;

            tmp = (isbit + .5)/sbit_max;

8165 8166
            if (tmp <= 0)
               tmp = 0;
8167

8168 8169 8170 8171 8172 8173 8174 8175 8176 8177 8178 8179
            else if (alpha >= 0 && vi->file_inverse > 0 && tmp < 1)
               tmp = pow(tmp, vi->file_inverse);

            tmp = gamma_component_compose(do_background, tmp, alpha, background,
               NULL);

            if (output_is_encoded && tmp > 0 && tmp < 1)
               tmp = pow(tmp, vi->screen_inverse);

            is_hi = floor(outmax * tmp + vi->maxout_total);

            if (is_hi > outmax)
8180 8181
               is_hi = outmax;

8182
            if (!(od < is_lo || od > is_hi))
8183 8184 8185 8186 8187 8188
            {
               if (encoded_error < vi->outlog)
                  return i;

               pass = "within input precision limits:\n";
            }
8189 8190 8191 8192 8193

            /* One last chance.  If this is an alpha channel and the 16to8
             * option has been used and 'inaccurate' scaling is used then the
             * bit reduction is obtained by simply using the top 8 bits of the
             * value.
8194 8195 8196
             *
             * This is only done for older libpng versions when the 'inaccurate'
             * (chop) method of scaling was used.
8197
             */
8198 8199 8200 8201 8202 8203 8204 8205 8206 8207
#           ifndef PNG_READ_16_TO_8_ACCURATE_SCALE_SUPPORTED
#              if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10504
                  /* This may be required for other components in the future,
                   * but at present the presence of gamma correction effectively
                   * prevents the errors in the component scaling (I don't quite
                   * understand why, but since it's better this way I care not
                   * to ask, JB 20110419.)
                   */
                  if (pass == 0 && alpha < 0 && vi->scale16 && vi->sbit > 8 &&
                     vi->sbit + vi->isbit_shift == 16)
8208
                  {
8209
                     tmp = ((id >> 8) - .5)/255;
8210

8211 8212 8213 8214 8215
                     if (tmp > 0)
                     {
                        is_lo = ceil(outmax * tmp - vi->maxout_total);
                        if (is_lo < 0) is_lo = 0;
                     }
8216

8217 8218
                     else
                        is_lo = 0;
8219

8220
                     tmp = ((id >> 8) + .5)/255;
8221

8222 8223 8224 8225 8226
                     if (tmp < 1)
                     {
                        is_hi = floor(outmax * tmp + vi->maxout_total);
                        if (is_hi > outmax) is_hi = outmax;
                     }
8227

8228 8229
                     else
                        is_hi = outmax;
8230

8231 8232 8233 8234 8235 8236 8237
                     if (!(od < is_lo || od > is_hi))
                     {
                        if (encoded_error < vi->outlog)
                           return i;

                        pass = "within 8 bit limits:\n";
                     }
8238
                  }
8239
#              endif
8240 8241 8242 8243 8244
#           endif
         }
         else /* !use_input_precision */
            is_lo = es_lo, is_hi = es_hi;

8245 8246 8247 8248
         /* Attempt to output a meaningful error/warning message: the message
          * output depends on the background/composite operation being performed
          * because this changes what parameters were actually used above.
          */
8249
         {
8250 8251 8252 8253 8254 8255
            size_t pos = 0;
            /* Need either 1/255 or 1/65535 precision here; 3 or 6 decimal
             * places.  Just use outmax to work out which.
             */
            int precision = (outmax >= 1000 ? 6 : 3);
            int use_input=1, use_background=0, do_compose=0;
8256 8257
            char msg[256];

8258 8259
            if (pass != 0)
               pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\n\t");
8260

8261 8262 8263 8264 8265
            /* Set up the various flags, the output_is_encoded flag above
             * is also used below.  do_compose is just a double check.
             */
            switch (do_background)
            {
8266 8267 8268 8269 8270 8271 8272
#           ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
               case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_SCREEN:
               case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE:
               case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_UNIQUE:
                  use_background = (alpha >= 0 && alpha < 1);
                  /*FALL THROUGH*/
#           endif
8273 8274 8275 8276 8277
#           ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
               case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD:
               case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN:
               case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED:
#           endif /* ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED */
8278
               do_compose = (alpha > 0 && alpha < 1);
8279 8280 8281 8282 8283 8284 8285 8286 8287 8288 8289 8290 8291 8292 8293 8294 8295 8296 8297 8298 8299 8300 8301 8302 8303 8304 8305 8306 8307 8308 8309 8310 8311 8312 8313 8314 8315 8316 8317 8318 8319 8320 8321 8322 8323 8324 8325 8326 8327 8328 8329 8330 8331 8332 8333 8334 8335 8336 8337 8338 8339 8340 8341 8342 8343 8344 8345 8346 8347 8348 8349 8350 8351 8352 8353 8354 8355 8356 8357 8358 8359 8360 8361 8362 8363 8364 8365 8366 8367 8368 8369 8370 8371 8372 8373 8374 8375 8376 8377 8378 8379 8380 8381 8382 8383 8384 8385 8386 8387 8388 8389 8390 8391 8392 8393 8394 8395 8396 8397 8398 8399 8400 8401 8402 8403 8404 8405 8406 8407 8408 8409 8410 8411 8412 8413 8414 8415 8416 8417 8418 8419 8420 8421 8422 8423 8424
               use_input = (alpha != 0);
               break;

            default:
               break;
            }

            /* Check the 'compose' flag */
            if (compose != do_compose)
               png_error(vi->pp, "internal error (compose)");

            /* 'name' is the component name */
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, name);
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "(");
            pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, id);
            if (use_input || pass != 0/*logging*/)
            {
               if (isbit != id)
               {
                  /* sBIT has reduced the precision of the input: */
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ", sbit(");
                  pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->sbit);
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "): ");
                  pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, isbit);
               }
               pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "/");
               /* The output is either "id/max" or "id sbit(sbit): isbit/max" */
               pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->sbit_max);
            }
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ")");

            /* A component may have been multiplied (in linear space) by the
             * alpha value, 'compose' says whether this is relevant.
             */
            if (compose || pass != 0)
            {
               /* If any form of composition is being done report our
                * calculated linear value here (the code above doesn't record
                * the input value before composition is performed, so what
                * gets reported is the value after composition.)
                */
               if (use_input || pass != 0)
               {
                  if (vi->file_inverse > 0)
                  {
                     pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "^");
                     pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->file_inverse, 2);
                  }

                  else
                     pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "[linear]");

                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "*(alpha)");
                  pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, alpha, precision);
               }

               /* Now record the *linear* background value if it was used
                * (this function is not passed the original, non-linear,
                * value but it is contained in the test name.)
                */
               if (use_background)
               {
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, use_input ? "+" : " ");
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "(background)");
                  pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, background, precision);
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "*");
                  pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, 1-alpha, precision);
               }
            }

            /* Report the calculated value (input_sample) and the linearized
             * libpng value (output) unless this is just a component gamma
             * correction.
             */
            if (compose || alpha < 0 || pass != 0)
            {
               pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos,
                  pass != 0 ? " =\n\t" : " = ");
               pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, input_sample, precision);
               pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " (libpng: ");
               pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, output, precision);
               pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ")");

               /* Finally report the output gamma encoding, if any. */
               if (output_is_encoded)
               {
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " ^");
                  pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->screen_inverse, 2);
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "(to screen) =");
               }

               else
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " [screen is linear] =");
            }

            if ((!compose && alpha >= 0) || pass != 0)
            {
               if (pass != 0) /* logging */
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\n\t[overall:");

               /* This is the non-composition case, the internal linear
                * values are irrelevant (though the log below will reveal
                * them.)  Output a much shorter warning/error message and report
                * the overall gamma correction.
                */
               if (vi->gamma_correction > 0)
               {
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " ^");
                  pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->gamma_correction, 2);
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "(gamma correction) =");
               }

               else
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos,
                     " [no gamma correction] =");

               if (pass != 0)
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "]");
            }

            /* This is our calculated encoded_sample which should (but does
             * not) match od:
             */
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, pass != 0 ? "\n\t" : " ");
            pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, is_lo, 1);
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " < ");
            pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, encoded_sample, 1);
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " (libpng: ");
            pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, od);
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ")");
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "/");
            pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, outmax);
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " < ");
            pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, is_hi, 1);

            if (pass == 0) /* The error condition */
            {
#              ifdef PNG_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED
                  png_warning(vi->pp, msg);
#              else
                  store_warning(vi->pp, msg);
#              endif
            }

            else /* logging this value */
               store_verbose(&vi->dp->pm->this, vi->pp, pass, msg);
8425 8426 8427 8428 8429 8430 8431
         }
      }
   }

   return i;
}

8432
static void
8433 8434
gamma_image_validate(gamma_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
   png_infop pi)
8435 8436
{
   /* Get some constants derived from the input and output file formats: */
8437
   PNG_CONST png_store* PNG_CONST ps = dp->this.ps;
8438 8439 8440 8441 8442 8443 8444 8445 8446 8447 8448
   PNG_CONST png_byte in_ct = dp->this.colour_type;
   PNG_CONST png_byte in_bd = dp->this.bit_depth;
   PNG_CONST png_uint_32 w = dp->this.w;
   PNG_CONST png_uint_32 h = dp->this.h;
   PNG_CONST size_t cbRow = dp->this.cbRow;
   PNG_CONST png_byte out_ct = png_get_color_type(pp, pi);
   PNG_CONST png_byte out_bd = png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi);

   /* There are three sources of error, firstly the quantization in the
    * file encoding, determined by sbit and/or the file depth, secondly
    * the output (screen) gamma and thirdly the output file encoding.
8449
    *
8450 8451 8452 8453 8454 8455 8456
    * Since this API receives the screen and file gamma in double
    * precision it is possible to calculate an exact answer given an input
    * pixel value.  Therefore we assume that the *input* value is exact -
    * sample/maxsample - calculate the corresponding gamma corrected
    * output to the limits of double precision arithmetic and compare with
    * what libpng returns.
    *
8457
    * Since the library must quantize the output to 8 or 16 bits there is
8458
    * a fundamental limit on the accuracy of the output of +/-.5 - this
8459
    * quantization limit is included in addition to the other limits
8460 8461 8462 8463 8464 8465
    * specified by the paramaters to the API.  (Effectively, add .5
    * everywhere.)
    *
    * The behavior of the 'sbit' paramter is defined by section 12.5
    * (sample depth scaling) of the PNG spec.  That section forces the
    * decoder to assume that the PNG values have been scaled if sBIT is
8466
    * present:
8467
    *
8468
    *     png-sample = floor( input-sample * (max-out/max-in) + .5);
8469 8470
    *
    * This means that only a subset of the possible PNG values should
8471
    * appear in the input. However, the spec allows the encoder to use a
8472 8473 8474 8475 8476 8477 8478 8479 8480 8481
    * variety of approximations to the above and doesn't require any
    * restriction of the values produced.
    *
    * Nevertheless the spec requires that the upper 'sBIT' bits of the
    * value stored in a PNG file be the original sample bits.
    * Consequently the code below simply scales the top sbit bits by
    * (1<<sbit)-1 to obtain an original sample value.
    *
    * Because there is limited precision in the input it is arguable that
    * an acceptable result is any valid result from input-.5 to input+.5.
8482 8483
    * The basic tests below do not do this, however if 'use_input_precision'
    * is set a subsequent test is performed below.
8484 8485
    */
   PNG_CONST unsigned int samples_per_pixel = (out_ct & 2U) ? 3U : 1U;
8486 8487
   int processing;
   png_uint_32 y;
8488 8489 8490 8491 8492
   PNG_CONST store_palette_entry *in_palette = dp->this.palette;
   PNG_CONST int in_is_transparent = dp->this.is_transparent;
   int out_npalette = -1;
   int out_is_transparent = 0; /* Just refers to the palette case */
   store_palette out_palette;
8493
   validate_info vi;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8494

8495 8496 8497
   /* Check for row overwrite errors */
   store_image_check(dp->this.ps, pp, 0);

8498 8499 8500 8501
   /* Supply the input and output sample depths here - 8 for an indexed image,
    * otherwise the bit depth.
    */
   init_validate_info(&vi, dp, pp, in_ct==3?8:in_bd, out_ct==3?8:out_bd);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8502

8503
   processing = (vi.gamma_correction > 0 && !dp->threshold_test)
8504
      || in_bd != out_bd || in_ct != out_ct || vi.do_background;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8505

8506 8507 8508 8509 8510 8511 8512 8513 8514 8515 8516 8517 8518
   /* TODO: FIX THIS: MAJOR BUG!  If the transformations all happen inside
    * the palette there is no way of finding out, because libpng fails to
    * update the palette on png_read_update_info.  Indeed, libpng doesn't
    * even do the required work until much later, when it doesn't have any
    * info pointer.  Oops.  For the moment 'processing' is turned off if
    * out_ct is palette.
    */
   if (in_ct == 3 && out_ct == 3)
      processing = 0;

   if (processing && out_ct == 3)
      out_is_transparent = read_palette(out_palette, &out_npalette, pp, pi);

8519
   for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
8520
   {
8521
      png_const_bytep pRow = store_image_row(ps, pp, 0, y);
8522
      png_byte std[STANDARD_ROWMAX];
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8523

8524
      transform_row(pp, std, in_ct, in_bd, y);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8525

8526
      if (processing)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8527
      {
8528
         unsigned int x;
8529

8530 8531 8532
         for (x=0; x<w; ++x)
         {
            double alpha = 1; /* serves as a flag value */
8533

8534 8535 8536 8537 8538 8539
            /* Record the palette index for index images. */
            PNG_CONST unsigned int in_index =
               in_ct == 3 ? sample(std, 3, in_bd, x, 0) : 256;
            PNG_CONST unsigned int out_index =
               out_ct == 3 ? sample(std, 3, out_bd, x, 0) : 256;

8540 8541
            /* Handle input alpha - png_set_background will cause the output
             * alpha to disappear so there is nothing to check.
8542
             */
8543 8544
            if ((in_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0 || (in_ct == 3 &&
               in_is_transparent))
8545
            {
8546 8547
               PNG_CONST unsigned int input_alpha = in_ct == 3 ?
                  dp->this.palette[in_index].alpha :
8548
                  sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, samples_per_pixel);
8549

8550
               unsigned int output_alpha = 65536 /* as a flag value */;
8551

8552 8553 8554 8555 8556 8557 8558 8559 8560 8561 8562
               if (out_ct == 3)
               {
                  if (out_is_transparent)
                     output_alpha = out_palette[out_index].alpha;
               }

               else if ((out_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0)
                  output_alpha = sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x,
                     samples_per_pixel);

               if (output_alpha != 65536)
8563
                  alpha = gamma_component_validate("alpha", &vi, input_alpha,
8564 8565 8566
                     output_alpha, -1/*alpha*/, 0/*background*/);

               else /* no alpha in output */
8567
               {
8568 8569 8570
                  /* This is a copy of the calculation of 'i' above in order to
                   * have the alpha value to use in the background calculation.
                   */
8571 8572
                  alpha = input_alpha >> vi.isbit_shift;
                  alpha /= vi.sbit_max;
8573 8574
               }
            }
8575

8576 8577
            /* Handle grayscale or RGB components. */
            if ((in_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) == 0) /* grayscale */
8578 8579 8580 8581
               (void)gamma_component_validate("gray", &vi,
                  sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 0),
                  sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, 0), alpha/*component*/,
                  vi.background_red);
8582
            else /* RGB or palette */
8583
            {
8584
               (void)gamma_component_validate("red", &vi,
8585 8586 8587 8588 8589
                  in_ct == 3 ? in_palette[in_index].red :
                     sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 0),
                  out_ct == 3 ? out_palette[out_index].red :
                     sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, 0),
                  alpha/*component*/, vi.background_red);
8590 8591

               (void)gamma_component_validate("green", &vi,
8592 8593 8594 8595 8596
                  in_ct == 3 ? in_palette[in_index].green :
                     sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 1),
                  out_ct == 3 ? out_palette[out_index].green :
                     sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, 1),
                  alpha/*component*/, vi.background_green);
8597 8598

               (void)gamma_component_validate("blue", &vi,
8599 8600 8601 8602 8603
                  in_ct == 3 ? in_palette[in_index].blue :
                     sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 2),
                  out_ct == 3 ? out_palette[out_index].blue :
                     sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, 2),
                  alpha/*component*/, vi.background_blue);
8604 8605 8606
            }
         }
      }
8607

8608
      else if (memcmp(std, pRow, cbRow) != 0)
8609 8610
      {
         char msg[64];
8611

8612
         /* No transform is expected on the threshold tests. */
8613 8614
         sprintf(msg, "gamma: below threshold row %lu changed",
            (unsigned long)y);
8615

8616 8617 8618
         png_error(pp, msg);
      }
   } /* row (y) loop */
8619

8620 8621
   dp->this.ps->validated = 1;
}
8622

8623
static void
8624
gamma_end(png_structp ppIn, png_infop pi)
8625
{
8626
   png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
8627
   gamma_display *dp = voidcast(gamma_display*, png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
8628

8629 8630
   if (!dp->this.speed)
      gamma_image_validate(dp, pp, pi);
8631 8632
   else
      dp->this.ps->validated = 1;
8633
}
8634

8635 8636 8637 8638 8639 8640 8641 8642
/* A single test run checking a gamma transformation.
 *
 * maxabs: maximum absolute error as a fraction
 * maxout: maximum output error in the output units
 * maxpc:  maximum percentage error (as a percentage)
 */
static void
gamma_test(png_modifier *pmIn, PNG_CONST png_byte colour_typeIn,
8643 8644
    PNG_CONST png_byte bit_depthIn, PNG_CONST int palette_numberIn,
    PNG_CONST int interlace_typeIn,
8645 8646
    PNG_CONST double file_gammaIn, PNG_CONST double screen_gammaIn,
    PNG_CONST png_byte sbitIn, PNG_CONST int threshold_testIn,
8647
    PNG_CONST char *name,
8648
    PNG_CONST int use_input_precisionIn, PNG_CONST int scale16In,
8649 8650
    PNG_CONST int expand16In, PNG_CONST int do_backgroundIn,
    PNG_CONST png_color_16 *bkgd_colorIn, double bkgd_gammaIn)
8651 8652 8653
{
   gamma_display d;
   context(&pmIn->this, fault);
8654

8655
   gamma_display_init(&d, pmIn, FILEID(colour_typeIn, bit_depthIn,
8656 8657
      palette_numberIn, interlace_typeIn, 0, 0, 0),
      file_gammaIn, screen_gammaIn, sbitIn,
8658
      threshold_testIn, use_input_precisionIn, scale16In,
8659
      expand16In, do_backgroundIn, bkgd_colorIn, bkgd_gammaIn);
8660

8661 8662 8663 8664
   Try
   {
      png_structp pp;
      png_infop pi;
8665
      gama_modification gama_mod;
8666 8667
      srgb_modification srgb_mod;
      sbit_modification sbit_mod;
8668

8669 8670 8671 8672 8673
      /* For the moment don't use the png_modifier support here. */
      d.pm->encoding_counter = 0;
      modifier_set_encoding(d.pm); /* Just resets everything */
      d.pm->current_gamma = d.file_gamma;

8674 8675 8676 8677
      /* Make an appropriate modifier to set the PNG file gamma to the
       * given gamma value and the sBIT chunk to the given precision.
       */
      d.pm->modifications = NULL;
8678
      gama_modification_init(&gama_mod, d.pm, d.file_gamma);
8679
      srgb_modification_init(&srgb_mod, d.pm, 127 /*delete*/);
8680 8681
      if (d.sbit > 0)
         sbit_modification_init(&sbit_mod, d.pm, d.sbit);
8682

8683 8684 8685 8686
      modification_reset(d.pm->modifications);

      /* Get a png_struct for writing the image. */
      pp = set_modifier_for_read(d.pm, &pi, d.this.id, name);
8687
      standard_palette_init(&d.this);
8688

8689 8690 8691 8692 8693 8694 8695 8696 8697 8698 8699 8700 8701 8702 8703 8704 8705 8706
      /* Introduce the correct read function. */
      if (d.pm->this.progressive)
      {
         /* Share the row function with the standard implementation. */
         png_set_progressive_read_fn(pp, &d, gamma_info, progressive_row,
            gamma_end);

         /* Now feed data into the reader until we reach the end: */
         modifier_progressive_read(d.pm, pp, pi);
      }
      else
      {
         /* modifier_read expects a png_modifier* */
         png_set_read_fn(pp, d.pm, modifier_read);

         /* Check the header values: */
         png_read_info(pp, pi);

8707
         /* Process the 'info' requirements. Only one image is generated */
8708 8709
         gamma_info_imp(&d, pp, pi);

8710
         sequential_row(&d.this, pp, pi, -1, 0);
8711

8712 8713
         if (!d.this.speed)
            gamma_image_validate(&d, pp, pi);
8714 8715
         else
            d.this.ps->validated = 1;
8716 8717
      }

8718
      modifier_reset(d.pm);
8719

8720
      if (d.pm->log && !d.threshold_test && !d.this.speed)
8721
         fprintf(stderr, "%d bit %s %s: max error %f (%.2g, %2g%%)\n",
8722
            d.this.bit_depth, colour_types[d.this.colour_type], name,
8723
            d.maxerrout, d.maxerrabs, 100*d.maxerrpc);
8724 8725

      /* Log the summary values too. */
8726
      if (d.this.colour_type == 0 || d.this.colour_type == 4)
8727
      {
8728
         switch (d.this.bit_depth)
8729
         {
8730 8731 8732 8733
         case 1:
            break;

         case 2:
8734 8735
            if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_gray_2)
               d.pm->error_gray_2 = d.maxerrout;
8736

8737 8738 8739
            break;

         case 4:
8740 8741
            if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_gray_4)
               d.pm->error_gray_4 = d.maxerrout;
8742

8743 8744 8745
            break;

         case 8:
8746 8747
            if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_gray_8)
               d.pm->error_gray_8 = d.maxerrout;
8748

8749 8750 8751
            break;

         case 16:
8752 8753
            if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_gray_16)
               d.pm->error_gray_16 = d.maxerrout;
8754

8755 8756 8757 8758
            break;

         default:
            png_error(pp, "bad bit depth (internal: 1)");
8759
         }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8760 8761
      }

8762
      else if (d.this.colour_type == 2 || d.this.colour_type == 6)
8763
      {
8764
         switch (d.this.bit_depth)
8765 8766
         {
         case 8:
8767

8768 8769
            if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_color_8)
               d.pm->error_color_8 = d.maxerrout;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8770

8771
            break;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8772

8773
         case 16:
8774

8775 8776
            if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_color_16)
               d.pm->error_color_16 = d.maxerrout;
8777 8778 8779 8780 8781 8782 8783

            break;

         default:
            png_error(pp, "bad bit depth (internal: 2)");
         }
      }
8784 8785 8786 8787 8788 8789

      else if (d.this.colour_type == 3)
      {
         if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_indexed)
            d.pm->error_indexed = d.maxerrout;
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8790
   }
8791 8792

   Catch(fault)
8793
      modifier_reset(voidcast(png_modifier*,(void*)fault));
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8794 8795 8796
}

static void gamma_threshold_test(png_modifier *pm, png_byte colour_type,
8797 8798
    png_byte bit_depth, int interlace_type, double file_gamma,
    double screen_gamma)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8799 8800 8801 8802 8803 8804 8805 8806
{
   size_t pos = 0;
   char name[64];
   pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "threshold ");
   pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, file_gamma, 3);
   pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "/");
   pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, screen_gamma, 3);

8807
   (void)gamma_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, 0/*palette*/, interlace_type,
8808
      file_gamma, screen_gamma, 0/*sBIT*/, 1/*threshold test*/, name,
8809
      0 /*no input precision*/,
8810
      0 /*no scale16*/, 0 /*no expand16*/, 0 /*no background*/, 0 /*hence*/,
8811
      0 /*no background gamma*/);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8812 8813 8814 8815 8816 8817 8818
}

static void
perform_gamma_threshold_tests(png_modifier *pm)
{
   png_byte colour_type = 0;
   png_byte bit_depth = 0;
8819
   unsigned int palette_number = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8820

8821 8822 8823 8824 8825 8826
   /* Don't test more than one instance of each palette - it's pointless, in
    * fact this test is somewhat excessive since libpng doesn't make this
    * decision based on colour type or bit depth!
    */
   while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number))
      if (palette_number == 0)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8827
   {
8828 8829
      double test_gamma = 1.0;
      while (test_gamma >= .4)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8830
      {
8831 8832 8833 8834
         /* There's little point testing the interlacing vs non-interlacing,
          * but this can be set from the command line.
          */
         gamma_threshold_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, pm->interlace_type,
8835 8836
            test_gamma, 1/test_gamma);
         test_gamma *= .95;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8837 8838 8839
      }

      /* And a special test for sRGB */
8840 8841
      gamma_threshold_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, pm->interlace_type,
          .45455, 2.2);
8842 8843 8844

      if (fail(pm))
         return;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8845 8846 8847
   }
}

8848 8849
static void gamma_transform_test(png_modifier *pm,
   PNG_CONST png_byte colour_type, PNG_CONST png_byte bit_depth,
8850
   PNG_CONST int palette_number,
8851
   PNG_CONST int interlace_type, PNG_CONST double file_gamma,
8852
   PNG_CONST double screen_gamma, PNG_CONST png_byte sbit,
8853
   PNG_CONST int use_input_precision, PNG_CONST int scale16)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8854 8855 8856
{
   size_t pos = 0;
   char name[64];
8857

8858
   if (sbit != bit_depth && sbit != 0)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8859 8860 8861 8862 8863
   {
      pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "sbit(");
      pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, sbit);
      pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, ") ");
   }
8864

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8865 8866
   else
      pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "gamma ");
8867

8868
   if (scale16)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8869
      pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "16to8 ");
8870

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8871 8872 8873 8874
   pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, file_gamma, 3);
   pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "->");
   pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, screen_gamma, 3);

8875 8876
   gamma_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number, interlace_type,
      file_gamma, screen_gamma, sbit, 0, name, use_input_precision,
8877
      scale16, pm->test_gamma_expand16, 0 , 0, 0);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8878 8879
}

8880
static void perform_gamma_transform_tests(png_modifier *pm)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8881 8882 8883
{
   png_byte colour_type = 0;
   png_byte bit_depth = 0;
8884
   unsigned int palette_number = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8885

8886
   while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number))
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8887
   {
8888
      unsigned int i, j;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8889

8890 8891 8892 8893 8894 8895
      for (i=0; i<pm->ngamma_tests; ++i) for (j=0; j<pm->ngamma_tests; ++j)
         if (i != j)
         {
            gamma_transform_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
               pm->interlace_type, 1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], 0/*sBIT*/,
               pm->use_input_precision, 0 /*do not scale16*/);
8896

8897 8898 8899
            if (fail(pm))
               return;
         }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8900 8901 8902
   }
}

8903
static void perform_gamma_sbit_tests(png_modifier *pm)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8904 8905 8906 8907
{
   png_byte sbit;

   /* The only interesting cases are colour and grayscale, alpha is ignored here
8908 8909
    * for overall speed.  Only bit depths where sbit is less than the bit depth
    * are tested.
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8910
    */
8911
   for (sbit=pm->sbitlow; sbit<(1<<READ_BDHI); ++sbit)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8912
   {
8913 8914
      png_byte colour_type = 0, bit_depth = 0;
      unsigned int npalette = 0;
8915

8916 8917 8918 8919 8920 8921
      while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &npalette))
         if ((colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) == 0 &&
            ((colour_type == 3 && sbit < 8) ||
            (colour_type != 3 && sbit < bit_depth)))
      {
         unsigned int i;
8922

8923
         for (i=0; i<pm->ngamma_tests; ++i)
8924 8925
         {
            unsigned int j;
8926

8927
            for (j=0; j<pm->ngamma_tests; ++j) if (i != j)
8928 8929 8930
            {
               gamma_transform_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, npalette,
                  pm->interlace_type, 1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j],
8931
                  sbit, pm->use_input_precision_sbit, 0 /*scale16*/);
8932 8933 8934 8935

               if (fail(pm))
                  return;
            }
8936
         }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8937 8938 8939 8940
      }
   }
}

8941
/* Note that this requires a 16 bit source image but produces 8 bit output, so
8942 8943
 * we only need the 16bit write support, but the 16 bit images are only
 * generated if DO_16BIT is defined.
8944
 */
8945
#ifdef DO_16BIT
8946
static void perform_gamma_scale16_tests(png_modifier *pm)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8947 8948 8949 8950
{
#  ifndef PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8
#     define PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8 11
#  endif
8951
   /* Include the alpha cases here. Note that sbit matches the internal value
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8952 8953 8954
    * used by the library - otherwise we will get spurious errors from the
    * internal sbit style approximation.
    *
8955
    * The threshold test is here because otherwise the 16 to 8 conversion will
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8956 8957 8958
    * proceed *without* gamma correction, and the tests above will fail (but not
    * by much) - this could be fixed, it only appears with the -g option.
    */
8959
   unsigned int i, j;
8960
   for (i=0; i<pm->ngamma_tests; ++i)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8961
   {
8962
      for (j=0; j<pm->ngamma_tests; ++j)
8963 8964 8965 8966
      {
         if (i != j &&
             fabs(pm->gammas[j]/pm->gammas[i]-1) >= PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
         {
8967 8968
            gamma_transform_test(pm, 0, 16, 0, pm->interlace_type,
               1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8,
8969
               pm->use_input_precision_16to8, 1 /*scale16*/);
8970 8971 8972 8973

            if (fail(pm))
               return;

8974 8975
            gamma_transform_test(pm, 2, 16, 0, pm->interlace_type,
               1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8,
8976
               pm->use_input_precision_16to8, 1 /*scale16*/);
8977 8978 8979 8980

            if (fail(pm))
               return;

8981 8982
            gamma_transform_test(pm, 4, 16, 0, pm->interlace_type,
               1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8,
8983
               pm->use_input_precision_16to8, 1 /*scale16*/);
8984 8985 8986 8987

            if (fail(pm))
               return;

8988 8989
            gamma_transform_test(pm, 6, 16, 0, pm->interlace_type,
               1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8,
8990
               pm->use_input_precision_16to8, 1 /*scale16*/);
8991 8992 8993 8994 8995

            if (fail(pm))
               return;
         }
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8996 8997
   }
}
8998
#endif /* 16 to 8 bit conversion */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8999

9000 9001
#if defined(PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED) ||\
   defined(PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED)
9002 9003
static void gamma_composition_test(png_modifier *pm,
   PNG_CONST png_byte colour_type, PNG_CONST png_byte bit_depth,
9004
   PNG_CONST int palette_number,
9005
   PNG_CONST int interlace_type, PNG_CONST double file_gamma,
9006
   PNG_CONST double screen_gamma,
9007 9008 9009 9010 9011 9012 9013 9014 9015 9016 9017 9018 9019
   PNG_CONST int use_input_precision, PNG_CONST int do_background,
   PNG_CONST int expand_16)
{
   size_t pos = 0;
   png_const_charp base;
   double bg;
   char name[128];
   png_color_16 background;

   /* Make up a name and get an appropriate background gamma value. */
   switch (do_background)
   {
      default:
9020
         base = "";
9021 9022 9023
         bg = 4; /* should not be used */
         break;
      case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_SCREEN:
9024
         base = " bckg(Screen):";
9025 9026 9027
         bg = 1/screen_gamma;
         break;
      case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE:
9028
         base = " bckg(File):";
9029 9030 9031
         bg = file_gamma;
         break;
      case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_UNIQUE:
9032
         base = " bckg(Unique):";
9033 9034 9035 9036 9037 9038 9039 9040
         /* This tests the handling of a unique value, the math is such that the
          * value tends to be <1, but is neither screen nor file (even if they
          * match!)
          */
         bg = (file_gamma + screen_gamma) / 3;
         break;
#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_PNG:
9041
         base = " alpha(PNG)";
9042 9043 9044
         bg = 4; /* should not be used */
         break;
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD:
9045
         base = " alpha(Porter-Duff)";
9046 9047 9048
         bg = 4; /* should not be used */
         break;
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED:
9049
         base = " alpha(Optimized)";
9050 9051 9052
         bg = 4; /* should not be used */
         break;
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN:
9053
         base = " alpha(Broken)";
9054 9055 9056 9057 9058 9059 9060 9061 9062 9063 9064 9065 9066 9067 9068 9069 9070 9071 9072 9073 9074 9075 9076 9077 9078 9079 9080 9081 9082 9083 9084 9085 9086 9087 9088 9089 9090 9091
         bg = 4; /* should not be used */
         break;
#endif
   }

   /* Use random background values - the background is always presented in the
    * output space (8 or 16 bit components).
    */
   if (expand_16 || bit_depth == 16)
   {
      png_uint_32 r = random_32();

      background.red = (png_uint_16)r;
      background.green = (png_uint_16)(r >> 16);
      r = random_32();
      background.blue = (png_uint_16)r;
      background.gray = (png_uint_16)(r >> 16);
   }

   else /* 8 bit colors */
   {
      png_uint_32 r = random_32();

      background.red = (png_byte)r;
      background.green = (png_byte)(r >> 8);
      background.blue = (png_byte)(r >> 16);
      background.gray = (png_byte)(r >> 24);
   }

   background.index = 193; /* rgb(193,193,193) to detect errors */
   if (!(colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR))
   {
      /* Grayscale input, we do not convert to RGB (TBD), so we must set the
       * background to gray - else libpng seems to fail.
       */
      background.red = background.green = background.blue = background.gray;
   }

9092
   pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "gamma ");
9093
   pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, file_gamma, 3);
9094 9095 9096 9097
   pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "->");
   pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, screen_gamma, 3);

   pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, base);
9098 9099 9100
   if (do_background < ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET)
   {
      /* Include the background color and gamma in the name: */
9101
      pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "(");
9102 9103 9104 9105 9106 9107
      /* This assumes no expand gray->rgb - the current code won't handle that!
       */
      if (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR)
      {
         pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, background.red);
         pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, ",");
9108
         pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, background.green);
9109 9110 9111 9112 9113 9114 9115 9116 9117
         pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, ",");
         pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, background.blue);
      }
      else
         pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, background.gray);
      pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, ")^");
      pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, bg, 3);
   }

9118
   gamma_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number, interlace_type,
9119
      file_gamma, screen_gamma, 0/*sBIT*/, 0, name, use_input_precision,
9120 9121 9122 9123 9124
      0/*strip 16*/, expand_16, do_background, &background, bg);
}


static void
9125
perform_gamma_composition_tests(png_modifier *pm, int do_background,
9126 9127 9128 9129
   int expand_16)
{
   png_byte colour_type = 0;
   png_byte bit_depth = 0;
9130
   unsigned int palette_number = 0;
9131

9132 9133
   /* Skip the non-alpha cases - there is no setting of a transparency colour at
    * present.
9134
    */
9135 9136
   while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number))
      if ((colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0)
9137 9138 9139 9140
   {
      unsigned int i, j;

      /* Don't skip the i==j case here - it's relevant. */
9141
      for (i=0; i<pm->ngamma_tests; ++i) for (j=0; j<pm->ngamma_tests; ++j)
9142
      {
9143 9144
         gamma_composition_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
            pm->interlace_type, 1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j],
9145
            pm->use_input_precision, do_background, expand_16);
9146 9147 9148 9149 9150 9151 9152 9153 9154 9155 9156

         if (fail(pm))
            return;
      }
   }
}
#endif /* READ_BACKGROUND || READ_ALPHA_MODE */

static void
init_gamma_errors(png_modifier *pm)
{
9157 9158 9159
   pm->error_gray_2 = pm->error_gray_4 = pm->error_gray_8 = 0;
   pm->error_color_8 = 0;
   pm->error_indexed = 0;
9160 9161 9162 9163 9164 9165 9166 9167 9168 9169 9170 9171 9172 9173 9174
   pm->error_gray_16 = pm->error_color_16 = 0;
}

static void
summarize_gamma_errors(png_modifier *pm, png_const_charp who, int low_bit_depth)
{
   if (who)
      printf("Gamma correction with %s:\n", who);

   if (low_bit_depth)
   {
      printf("  2 bit gray:  %.5f\n", pm->error_gray_2);
      printf("  4 bit gray:  %.5f\n", pm->error_gray_4);
      printf("  8 bit gray:  %.5f\n", pm->error_gray_8);
      printf("  8 bit color: %.5f\n", pm->error_color_8);
9175
      printf("  indexed:     %.5f\n", pm->error_indexed);
9176 9177 9178 9179 9180 9181 9182 9183
   }

#ifdef DO_16BIT
   printf(" 16 bit gray:  %.5f\n", pm->error_gray_16);
   printf(" 16 bit color: %.5f\n", pm->error_color_16);
#endif
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9184
static void
9185
perform_gamma_test(png_modifier *pm, int summary)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9186
{
9187 9188 9189 9190
   /*TODO: remove this*/
   /* Save certain values for the temporary overrides below. */
   unsigned int calculations_use_input_precision =
      pm->calculations_use_input_precision;
9191 9192 9193
#  ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
      double maxout8 = pm->maxout8;
#  endif
9194

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9195
   /* First some arbitrary no-transform tests: */
9196
   if (!pm->this.speed && pm->test_gamma_threshold)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9197 9198
   {
      perform_gamma_threshold_tests(pm);
9199 9200 9201

      if (fail(pm))
         return;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9202 9203 9204
   }

   /* Now some real transforms. */
9205
   if (pm->test_gamma_transform)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9206
   {
9207
      init_gamma_errors(pm);
9208
      /*TODO: remove this.  Necessary because the current libpng
9209 9210 9211 9212
       * implementation works in 8 bits:
       */
      if (pm->test_gamma_expand16)
         pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 1;
9213
      perform_gamma_transform_tests(pm);
9214 9215
      if (!calculations_use_input_precision)
         pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 0;
9216

9217
      if (summary)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9218
      {
9219 9220 9221 9222 9223 9224 9225 9226 9227 9228 9229 9230 9231
         printf("Gamma correction error summary\n\n");
         printf("The printed value is the maximum error in the pixel values\n");
         printf("calculated by the libpng gamma correction code.  The error\n");
         printf("is calculated as the difference between the output pixel\n");
         printf("value (always an integer) and the ideal value from the\n");
         printf("libpng specification (typically not an integer).\n\n");

         printf("Expect this value to be less than .5 for 8 bit formats,\n");
         printf("less than 1 for formats with fewer than 8 bits and a small\n");
         printf("number (typically less than 5) for the 16 bit formats.\n");
         printf("For performance reasons the value for 16 bit formats\n");
         printf("increases when the image file includes an sBIT chunk.\n\n");

9232
         summarize_gamma_errors(pm, 0/*who*/, 1);
9233
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9234 9235
   }

9236
   /* The sbit tests produce much larger errors: */
9237
   if (pm->test_gamma_sbit)
9238
   {
9239
      init_gamma_errors(pm);
9240
      perform_gamma_sbit_tests(pm);
9241

9242
      if (summary)
9243
         summarize_gamma_errors(pm, "sBIT", pm->sbitlow < 8U);
9244 9245
   }

9246
#ifdef DO_16BIT /* Should be READ_16BIT_SUPPORTED */
9247
   if (pm->test_gamma_scale16)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9248
   {
9249
      /* The 16 to 8 bit strip operations: */
9250
      init_gamma_errors(pm);
9251
      perform_gamma_scale16_tests(pm);
9252 9253 9254 9255 9256 9257 9258

      if (summary)
      {
         printf("Gamma correction with 16 to 8 bit reduction:\n");
         printf(" 16 bit gray:  %.5f\n", pm->error_gray_16);
         printf(" 16 bit color: %.5f\n", pm->error_color_16);
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9259
   }
9260
#endif
9261 9262 9263 9264 9265 9266

#ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
   if (pm->test_gamma_background)
   {
      init_gamma_errors(pm);

9267
      /*TODO: remove this.  Necessary because the current libpng
9268 9269 9270 9271 9272 9273 9274
       * implementation works in 8 bits:
       */
      if (pm->test_gamma_expand16)
      {
         pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 1;
         pm->maxout8 = .499; /* because the 16 bit background is smashed */
      }
9275
      perform_gamma_composition_tests(pm, PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_UNIQUE,
9276
         pm->test_gamma_expand16);
9277 9278 9279
      if (!calculations_use_input_precision)
         pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 0;
      pm->maxout8 = maxout8;
9280 9281 9282 9283 9284 9285 9286 9287 9288 9289 9290 9291 9292

      if (summary)
         summarize_gamma_errors(pm, "background", 1);
   }
#endif

#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
   if (pm->test_gamma_alpha_mode)
   {
      int do_background;

      init_gamma_errors(pm);

9293
      /*TODO: remove this.  Necessary because the current libpng
9294 9295 9296 9297
       * implementation works in 8 bits:
       */
      if (pm->test_gamma_expand16)
         pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 1;
9298 9299 9300
      for (do_background = ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD;
         do_background <= ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN && !fail(pm);
         ++do_background)
9301
         perform_gamma_composition_tests(pm, do_background,
9302
            pm->test_gamma_expand16);
9303 9304
      if (!calculations_use_input_precision)
         pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 0;
9305 9306 9307 9308 9309

      if (summary)
         summarize_gamma_errors(pm, "alpha mode", 1);
   }
#endif
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9310
}
9311
#endif /* PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED */
9312
#endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9313

9314 9315 9316 9317 9318 9319 9320 9321 9322 9323 9324 9325 9326 9327 9328 9329 9330 9331 9332 9333 9334 9335 9336 9337 9338 9339 9340 9341 9342 9343 9344 9345 9346 9347 9348 9349 9350 9351 9352 9353 9354 9355 9356 9357 9358 9359 9360 9361 9362 9363 9364 9365 9366 9367 9368 9369 9370 9371 9372 9373 9374 9375 9376 9377 9378 9379 9380 9381 9382 9383 9384 9385 9386 9387 9388 9389 9390 9391 9392 9393 9394 9395 9396 9397 9398 9399 9400 9401 9402 9403 9404 9405 9406 9407 9408 9409 9410 9411 9412 9413 9414 9415 9416 9417 9418 9419 9420 9421 9422 9423 9424 9425 9426 9427 9428 9429 9430 9431 9432 9433 9434 9435 9436 9437 9438 9439 9440 9441 9442 9443 9444 9445 9446 9447 9448 9449 9450 9451 9452 9453 9454 9455 9456 9457 9458 9459 9460 9461 9462 9463 9464 9465 9466 9467 9468 9469 9470 9471 9472 9473 9474 9475 9476 9477 9478 9479 9480 9481 9482 9483 9484 9485 9486 9487 9488 9489 9490 9491 9492 9493 9494 9495 9496 9497 9498 9499 9500 9501 9502 9503 9504 9505 9506 9507 9508 9509 9510 9511 9512 9513 9514 9515 9516 9517 9518 9519 9520 9521 9522 9523 9524 9525 9526 9527 9528 9529 9530 9531 9532 9533 9534 9535 9536 9537 9538 9539 9540 9541 9542 9543 9544 9545 9546 9547 9548
/* INTERLACE MACRO VALIDATION */
/* This is copied verbatim from the specification, it is simply the pass
 * number in which each pixel in each 8x8 tile appears.  The array must
 * be indexed adam7[y][x] and notice that the pass numbers are based at
 * 1, not 0 - the base libpng uses.
 */
static PNG_CONST
png_byte adam7[8][8] =
{
   { 1,6,4,6,2,6,4,6 },
   { 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7 },
   { 5,6,5,6,5,6,5,6 },
   { 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7 },
   { 3,6,4,6,3,6,4,6 },
   { 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7 },
   { 5,6,5,6,5,6,5,6 },
   { 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7 }
};

/* This routine validates all the interlace support macros in png.h for
 * a variety of valid PNG widths and heights.  It uses a number of similarly
 * named internal routines that feed off the above array.
 */
static png_uint_32
png_pass_start_row(int pass)
{
   int x, y;
   ++pass;
   for (y=0; y<8; ++y) for (x=0; x<8; ++x) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
      return y;
   return 0xf;
}

static png_uint_32
png_pass_start_col(int pass)
{
   int x, y;
   ++pass;
   for (x=0; x<8; ++x) for (y=0; y<8; ++y) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
      return x;
   return 0xf;
}

static int
png_pass_row_shift(int pass)
{
   int x, y, base=(-1), inc=8;
   ++pass;
   for (y=0; y<8; ++y) for (x=0; x<8; ++x) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
   {
      if (base == (-1))
         base = y;
      else if (base == y)
         {}
      else if (inc == y-base)
         base=y;
      else if (inc == 8)
         inc = y-base, base=y;
      else if (inc != y-base)
         return 0xff; /* error - more than one 'inc' value! */
   }

   if (base == (-1)) return 0xfe; /* error - no row in pass! */

   /* The shift is always 1, 2 or 3 - no pass has all the rows! */
   switch (inc)
   {
case 2: return 1;
case 4: return 2;
case 8: return 3;
default: break;
   }

   /* error - unrecognized 'inc' */
   return (inc << 8) + 0xfd;
}

static int
png_pass_col_shift(int pass)
{
   int x, y, base=(-1), inc=8;
   ++pass;
   for (x=0; x<8; ++x) for (y=0; y<8; ++y) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
   {
      if (base == (-1))
         base = x;
      else if (base == x)
         {}
      else if (inc == x-base)
         base=x;
      else if (inc == 8)
         inc = x-base, base=x;
      else if (inc != x-base)
         return 0xff; /* error - more than one 'inc' value! */
   }

   if (base == (-1)) return 0xfe; /* error - no row in pass! */

   /* The shift is always 1, 2 or 3 - no pass has all the rows! */
   switch (inc)
   {
case 1: return 0; /* pass 7 has all the columns */
case 2: return 1;
case 4: return 2;
case 8: return 3;
default: break;
   }

   /* error - unrecognized 'inc' */
   return (inc << 8) + 0xfd;
}

static png_uint_32
png_row_from_pass_row(png_uint_32 yIn, int pass)
{
   /* By examination of the array: */
   switch (pass)
   {
case 0: return yIn * 8;
case 1: return yIn * 8;
case 2: return yIn * 8 + 4;
case 3: return yIn * 4;
case 4: return yIn * 4 + 2;
case 5: return yIn * 2;
case 6: return yIn * 2 + 1;
default: break;
   }

   return 0xff; /* bad pass number */
}

static png_uint_32
png_col_from_pass_col(png_uint_32 xIn, int pass)
{
   /* By examination of the array: */
   switch (pass)
   {
case 0: return xIn * 8;
case 1: return xIn * 8 + 4;
case 2: return xIn * 4;
case 3: return xIn * 4 + 2;
case 4: return xIn * 2;
case 5: return xIn * 2 + 1;
case 6: return xIn;
default: break;
   }

   return 0xff; /* bad pass number */
}

static int
png_row_in_interlace_pass(png_uint_32 y, int pass)
{
   /* Is row 'y' in pass 'pass'? */
   int x;
   y &= 7;
   ++pass;
   for (x=0; x<8; ++x) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
      return 1;

   return 0;
}

static int
png_col_in_interlace_pass(png_uint_32 x, int pass)
{
   /* Is column 'x' in pass 'pass'? */
   int y;
   x &= 7;
   ++pass;
   for (y=0; y<8; ++y) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
      return 1;

   return 0;
}

static png_uint_32
png_pass_rows(png_uint_32 height, int pass)
{
   png_uint_32 tiles = height>>3;
   png_uint_32 rows = 0;
   unsigned int x, y;

   height &= 7;
   ++pass;
   for (y=0; y<8; ++y) for (x=0; x<8; ++x) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
   {
      rows += tiles;
      if (y < height) ++rows;
      break; /* i.e. break the 'x', column, loop. */
   }

   return rows;
}

static png_uint_32
png_pass_cols(png_uint_32 width, int pass)
{
   png_uint_32 tiles = width>>3;
   png_uint_32 cols = 0;
   unsigned int x, y;

   width &= 7;
   ++pass;
   for (x=0; x<8; ++x) for (y=0; y<8; ++y) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
   {
      cols += tiles;
      if (x < width) ++cols;
      break; /* i.e. break the 'y', row, loop. */
   }

   return cols;
}

static void
perform_interlace_macro_validation(void)
{
   /* The macros to validate, first those that depend only on pass:
    *
    * PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass)
    * PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass)
    * PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass)
    * PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass)
    */
   int pass;

   for (pass=0; pass<7; ++pass)
   {
      png_uint_32 m, f, v;

      m = PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass);
      f = png_pass_start_row(pass);
      if (m != f)
      {
         fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_START_ROW(%d) = %u != %x\n", pass, m, f);
9549
         exit(99);
9550 9551 9552 9553 9554 9555 9556
      }

      m = PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass);
      f = png_pass_start_col(pass);
      if (m != f)
      {
         fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_START_COL(%d) = %u != %x\n", pass, m, f);
9557
         exit(99);
9558 9559 9560 9561 9562 9563 9564
      }

      m = PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass);
      f = png_pass_row_shift(pass);
      if (m != f)
      {
         fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(%d) = %u != %x\n", pass, m, f);
9565
         exit(99);
9566 9567 9568 9569 9570 9571 9572
      }

      m = PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass);
      f = png_pass_col_shift(pass);
      if (m != f)
      {
         fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(%d) = %u != %x\n", pass, m, f);
9573
         exit(99);
9574 9575 9576 9577 9578 9579 9580 9581 9582 9583 9584 9585 9586 9587 9588 9589 9590 9591 9592 9593
      }

      /* Macros that depend on the image or sub-image height too:
       *
       * PNG_PASS_ROWS(height, pass)
       * PNG_PASS_COLS(width, pass)
       * PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(yIn, pass)
       * PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(xIn, pass)
       * PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass)
       * PNG_COL_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(x, pass)
       */
      for (v=0;;)
      {
         /* First the base 0 stuff: */
         m = PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(v, pass);
         f = png_row_from_pass_row(v, pass);
         if (m != f)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
               v, pass, m, f);
9594
            exit(99);
9595 9596 9597 9598 9599 9600 9601 9602
         }

         m = PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(v, pass);
         f = png_col_from_pass_col(v, pass);
         if (m != f)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
               v, pass, m, f);
9603
            exit(99);
9604 9605 9606 9607 9608 9609 9610 9611
         }

         m = PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(v, pass);
         f = png_row_in_interlace_pass(v, pass);
         if (m != f)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
               v, pass, m, f);
9612
            exit(99);
9613 9614 9615 9616 9617 9618 9619 9620
         }

         m = PNG_COL_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(v, pass);
         f = png_col_in_interlace_pass(v, pass);
         if (m != f)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "PNG_COL_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
               v, pass, m, f);
9621
            exit(99);
9622 9623 9624 9625 9626 9627 9628 9629 9630 9631
         }

         /* Then the base 1 stuff: */
         ++v;
         m = PNG_PASS_ROWS(v, pass);
         f = png_pass_rows(v, pass);
         if (m != f)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_ROWS(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
               v, pass, m, f);
9632
            exit(99);
9633 9634 9635 9636 9637 9638 9639 9640
         }

         m = PNG_PASS_COLS(v, pass);
         f = png_pass_cols(v, pass);
         if (m != f)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_COLS(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
               v, pass, m, f);
9641
            exit(99);
9642 9643 9644 9645 9646 9647 9648 9649 9650 9651 9652 9653 9654 9655 9656 9657 9658 9659
         }

         /* Move to the next v - the stepping algorithm starts skipping
          * values above 1024.
          */
         if (v > 1024)
         {
            if (v == PNG_UINT_31_MAX)
               break;

            v = (v << 1) ^ v;
            if (v >= PNG_UINT_31_MAX)
               v = PNG_UINT_31_MAX-1;
         }
      }
   }
}

9660 9661 9662 9663 9664 9665 9666 9667 9668 9669 9670 9671 9672 9673 9674 9675 9676 9677 9678 9679 9680 9681 9682 9683 9684 9685 9686 9687 9688 9689 9690 9691 9692 9693 9694
/* Test color encodings. These values are back-calculated from the published
 * chromaticities.  The values are accurate to about 14 decimal places; 15 are
 * given.  These values are much more accurate than the ones given in the spec,
 * which typically don't exceed 4 decimal places.  This allows testing of the
 * libpng code to its theoretical accuracy of 4 decimal places.  (If pngvalid
 * used the published errors the 'slack' permitted would have to be +/-.5E-4 or
 * more.)
 *
 * The png_modifier code assumes that encodings[0] is sRGB and treats it
 * specially: do not change the first entry in this list!
 */
static PNG_CONST color_encoding test_encodings[] =
{
/* sRGB: must be first in this list! */
/*gamma:*/ { 1/2.2,
/*red:  */ { 0.412390799265959, 0.212639005871510, 0.019330818715592 },
/*green:*/ { 0.357584339383878, 0.715168678767756, 0.119194779794626 },
/*blue: */ { 0.180480788401834, 0.072192315360734, 0.950532152249660} },
/* Kodak ProPhoto (wide gamut) */
/*gamma:*/ { 1/1.6 /*approximate: uses 1.8 power law compared to sRGB 2.4*/,
/*red:  */ { 0.797760489672303, 0.288071128229293, 0.000000000000000 },
/*green:*/ { 0.135185837175740, 0.711843217810102, 0.000000000000000 },
/*blue: */ { 0.031349349581525, 0.000085653960605, 0.825104602510460} },
/* Adobe RGB (1998) */
/*gamma:*/ { 1/(2+51./256),
/*red:  */ { 0.576669042910131, 0.297344975250536, 0.027031361386412 },
/*green:*/ { 0.185558237906546, 0.627363566255466, 0.070688852535827 },
/*blue: */ { 0.188228646234995, 0.075291458493998, 0.991337536837639} },
/* Adobe Wide Gamut RGB */
/*gamma:*/ { 1/(2+51./256),
/*red:  */ { 0.716500716779386, 0.258728243040113, 0.000000000000000 },
/*green:*/ { 0.101020574397477, 0.724682314948566, 0.051211818965388 },
/*blue: */ { 0.146774385252705, 0.016589442011321, 0.773892783545073} },
};

9695 9696 9697 9698 9699 9700 9701 9702 9703 9704 9705 9706 9707 9708 9709 9710 9711 9712 9713 9714 9715 9716 9717 9718 9719 9720 9721 9722 9723 9724 9725 9726 9727 9728 9729 9730 9731 9732 9733 9734 9735 9736 9737 9738 9739 9740 9741 9742 9743 9744 9745 9746 9747 9748 9749 9750 9751 9752 9753 9754 9755 9756 9757 9758 9759 9760
/* signal handler
 *
 * This attempts to trap signals and escape without crashing.  It needs a
 * context pointer so that it can throw an exception (call longjmp) to recover
 * from the condition; this is handled by making the png_modifier used by 'main'
 * into a global variable.
 */
static png_modifier pm;

static void signal_handler(int signum)
{

   size_t pos = 0;
   char msg[64];

   pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "caught signal: ");

   switch (signum)
   {
      case SIGABRT:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "abort");
         break;

      case SIGFPE:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "floating point exception");
         break;

      case SIGILL:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "illegal instruction");
         break;

      case SIGINT:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "interrupt");
         break;

      case SIGSEGV:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "invalid memory access");
         break;

      case SIGTERM:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "termination request");
         break;

      default:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "unknown ");
         pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, signum);
         break;
   }

   store_log(&pm.this, NULL/*png_structp*/, msg, 1/*error*/);

   /* And finally throw an exception so we can keep going, unless this is
    * SIGTERM in which case stop now.
    */
   if (signum != SIGTERM)
   {
      struct exception_context *the_exception_context =
         &pm.this.exception_context;

      Throw &pm.this;
   }

   else
      exit(1);
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9761
/* main program */
9762
int main(int argc, char **argv)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9763
{
9764
   volatile int summary = 1;  /* Print the error summary at the end */
9765
   volatile int memstats = 0; /* Print memory statistics at the end */
9766 9767 9768

   /* Create the given output file on success: */
   PNG_CONST char *volatile touch = NULL;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9769 9770 9771 9772 9773 9774

   /* This is an array of standard gamma values (believe it or not I've seen
    * every one of these mentioned somewhere.)
    *
    * In the following list the most useful values are first!
    */
9775 9776
   static double
      gammas[]={2.2, 1.0, 2.2/1.45, 1.8, 1.5, 2.4, 2.5, 2.62, 2.9};
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9777

9778 9779 9780 9781
   /* This records the command and arguments: */
   size_t cp = 0;
   char command[1024];

9782
   anon_context(&pm.this);
9783

9784 9785 9786 9787 9788 9789 9790 9791 9792 9793 9794 9795 9796 9797 9798 9799
   /* Add appropriate signal handlers, just the ANSI specified ones: */
   signal(SIGABRT, signal_handler);
   signal(SIGFPE, signal_handler);
   signal(SIGILL, signal_handler);
   signal(SIGINT, signal_handler);
   signal(SIGSEGV, signal_handler);
   signal(SIGTERM, signal_handler);

#ifdef HAVE_FEENABLEEXCEPT
   /* Only required to enable FP exceptions on platforms where they start off
    * disabled; this is not necessary but if it is not done pngvalid will likely
    * end up ignoring FP conditions that other platforms fault.
    */
   feenableexcept(FE_DIVBYZERO | FE_INVALID | FE_OVERFLOW);
#endif

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9800 9801
   modifier_init(&pm);

9802
   /* Preallocate the image buffer, because we know how big it needs to be,
9803 9804 9805
    * note that, for testing purposes, it is deliberately mis-aligned by tag
    * bytes either side.  All rows have an additional five bytes of padding for
    * overwrite checking.
9806
    */
9807
   store_ensure_image(&pm.this, NULL, 2, TRANSFORM_ROWMAX, TRANSFORM_HEIGHTMAX);
9808

9809 9810 9811
   /* Don't give argv[0], it's normally some horrible libtool string: */
   cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, "pngvalid");

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9812 9813 9814 9815 9816
   /* Default to error on warning: */
   pm.this.treat_warnings_as_errors = 1;

   /* Store the test gammas */
   pm.gammas = gammas;
9817 9818 9819 9820 9821 9822 9823
   pm.ngammas = (sizeof gammas) / (sizeof gammas[0]);
   pm.ngamma_tests = 0; /* default to off */

   /* And the test encodings */
   pm.encodings = test_encodings;
   pm.nencodings = (sizeof test_encodings) / (sizeof test_encodings[0]);

9824
   pm.sbitlow = 8U; /* because libpng doesn't do sBIT below 8! */
9825 9826 9827 9828 9829 9830 9831
   /* The following allows results to pass if they correspond to anything in the
    * transformed range [input-.5,input+.5]; this is is required because of the
    * way libpng treates the 16_TO_8 flag when building the gamma tables.
    *
    * TODO: review this
    */
   pm.use_input_precision_16to8 = 1U;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9832

9833 9834 9835 9836 9837
   /* Some default values (set the behavior for 'make check' here).
    * These values simply control the maximum error permitted in the gamma
    * transformations.  The practial limits for human perception are described
    * below (the setting for maxpc16), however for 8 bit encodings it isn't
    * possible to meet the accepted capabilities of human vision - i.e. 8 bit
9838
    * images can never be good enough, regardless of encoding.
9839
    */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9840 9841
   pm.maxout8 = .1;     /* Arithmetic error in *encoded* value */
   pm.maxabs8 = .00005; /* 1/20000 */
9842
   pm.maxcalc8 = .004;  /* +/-1 in 8 bits for compose errors */
9843
   pm.maxpc8 = .499;    /* I.e., .499% fractional error */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9844 9845
   pm.maxout16 = .499;  /* Error in *encoded* value */
   pm.maxabs16 = .00005;/* 1/20000 */
9846
   pm.maxcalc16 =.000015;/* +/-1 in 16 bits for compose errors */
9847 9848

   /* NOTE: this is a reasonable perceptual limit. We assume that humans can
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9849
    * perceive light level differences of 1% over a 100:1 range, so we need to
9850
    * maintain 1 in 10000 accuracy (in linear light space), which is what the
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9851 9852 9853 9854 9855
    * following guarantees.  It also allows significantly higher errors at
    * higher 16 bit values, which is important for performance.  The actual
    * maximum 16 bit error is about +/-1.9 in the fixed point implementation but
    * this is only allowed for values >38149 by the following:
    */
9856
   pm.maxpc16 = .005;   /* I.e., 1/200% - 1/20000 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9857 9858 9859

   /* Now parse the command line options. */
   while (--argc >= 1)
9860
   {
9861 9862
      int catmore = 0; /* Set if the argument has an argument. */

9863 9864 9865 9866 9867
      /* Record each argument for posterity: */
      cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, " ");
      cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, *++argv);

      if (strcmp(*argv, "-v") == 0)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9868
         pm.this.verbose = 1;
9869

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9870 9871
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "-l") == 0)
         pm.log = 1;
9872

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9873
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "-q") == 0)
9874
         summary = pm.this.verbose = pm.log = 0;
9875

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9876 9877
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "-w") == 0)
         pm.this.treat_warnings_as_errors = 0;
9878

9879
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--speed") == 0)
9880 9881
         pm.this.speed = 1, pm.ngamma_tests = pm.ngammas, pm.test_standard = 0,
            summary = 0;
9882 9883 9884

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--memory") == 0)
         memstats = 1;
9885

9886 9887 9888
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--size") == 0)
         pm.test_size = 1;

9889 9890 9891 9892 9893 9894
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nosize") == 0)
         pm.test_size = 0;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--standard") == 0)
         pm.test_standard = 1;

9895 9896
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nostandard") == 0)
         pm.test_standard = 0;
9897

9898 9899 9900
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--transform") == 0)
         pm.test_transform = 1;

9901 9902 9903
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--notransform") == 0)
         pm.test_transform = 0;

9904
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
9905 9906 9907 9908 9909 9910 9911 9912 9913 9914 9915 9916 9917
      else if (strncmp(*argv, "--transform-disable=",
         sizeof "--transform-disable") == 0)
         {
         pm.test_transform = 1;
         transform_disable(*argv + sizeof "--transform-disable");
         }

      else if (strncmp(*argv, "--transform-enable=",
         sizeof "--transform-enable") == 0)
         {
         pm.test_transform = 1;
         transform_enable(*argv + sizeof "--transform-enable");
         }
9918
#endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
9919 9920 9921 9922

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma") == 0)
         {
         /* Just do two gamma tests here (2.2 and linear) for speed: */
9923
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U;
9924 9925 9926
         pm.test_gamma_threshold = 1;
         pm.test_gamma_transform = 1;
         pm.test_gamma_sbit = 1;
9927
         pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 1;
9928 9929
         pm.test_gamma_background = 1;
         pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 1;
9930 9931
         }

9932
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma") == 0)
9933
         pm.ngamma_tests = 0;
9934

9935
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-threshold") == 0)
9936
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_threshold = 1;
9937

9938
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-threshold") == 0)
9939
         pm.test_gamma_threshold = 0;
9940

9941
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-transform") == 0)
9942
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_transform = 1;
9943

9944
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-transform") == 0)
9945
         pm.test_gamma_transform = 0;
9946

9947
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-sbit") == 0)
9948
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_sbit = 1;
9949

9950
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-sbit") == 0)
9951
         pm.test_gamma_sbit = 0;
9952

9953
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-16-to-8") == 0)
9954
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 1;
9955

9956
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-16-to-8") == 0)
9957
         pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 0;
9958

9959
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-background") == 0)
9960
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_background = 1;
9961 9962 9963 9964 9965

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-background") == 0)
         pm.test_gamma_background = 0;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-alpha-mode") == 0)
9966
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 1;
9967 9968 9969 9970 9971 9972 9973 9974 9975 9976 9977

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-alpha-mode") == 0)
         pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 0;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--expand16") == 0)
         pm.test_gamma_expand16 = 1;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--noexpand16") == 0)
         pm.test_gamma_expand16 = 0;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--more-gammas") == 0)
9978
         pm.ngamma_tests = 3U;
9979

9980
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--all-gammas") == 0)
9981
         pm.ngamma_tests = pm.ngammas;
9982

9983 9984 9985
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--progressive-read") == 0)
         pm.this.progressive = 1;

9986 9987 9988
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--use-update-info") == 0)
         ++pm.use_update_info; /* Can call multiple times */

9989 9990 9991
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--interlace") == 0)
         pm.interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7;

9992 9993 9994
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--use-input-precision") == 0)
         pm.use_input_precision = 1;

9995 9996 9997 9998 9999
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--calculations-use-input-precision") == 0)
         pm.calculations_use_input_precision = 1;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--assume-16-bit-calculations") == 0)
         pm.assume_16_bit_calculations = 1;
10000

10001 10002 10003
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--calculations-follow-bit-depth") == 0)
         pm.calculations_use_input_precision =
            pm.assume_16_bit_calculations = 0;
10004

10005 10006 10007
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--exhaustive") == 0)
         pm.test_exhaustive = 1;

10008 10009
      else if (argc > 1 && strcmp(*argv, "--sbitlow") == 0)
         --argc, pm.sbitlow = (png_byte)atoi(*++argv), catmore = 1;
10010

10011 10012 10013 10014
      else if (argc > 1 && strcmp(*argv, "--touch") == 0)
         --argc, touch = *++argv, catmore = 1;

      else if (argc > 1 && strncmp(*argv, "--max", 5) == 0)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10015 10016
      {
         --argc;
10017

10018
         if (strcmp(5+*argv, "abs8") == 0)
10019
            pm.maxabs8 = atof(*++argv);
10020

10021
         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "abs16") == 0)
10022
            pm.maxabs16 = atof(*++argv);
10023

10024 10025 10026 10027 10028 10029 10030
         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "calc8") == 0)
            pm.maxcalc8 = atof(*++argv);

         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "calc16") == 0)
            pm.maxcalc16 = atof(*++argv);

         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "out8") == 0)
10031
            pm.maxout8 = atof(*++argv);
10032

10033
         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "out16") == 0)
10034
            pm.maxout16 = atof(*++argv);
10035

10036
         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "pc8") == 0)
10037
            pm.maxpc8 = atof(*++argv);
10038

10039
         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "pc16") == 0)
10040
            pm.maxpc16 = atof(*++argv);
10041

10042 10043 10044
         else
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %s: unknown 'max' option\n", *argv);
10045
            exit(99);
10046
         }
10047 10048

         catmore = 1;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10049
      }
10050

10051 10052 10053 10054 10055 10056
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--log8") == 0)
         --argc, pm.log8 = atof(*++argv), catmore = 1;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--log16") == 0)
         --argc, pm.log16 = atof(*++argv), catmore = 1;

10057 10058 10059 10060 10061 10062 10063 10064 10065 10066 10067 10068 10069 10070 10071 10072 10073 10074 10075 10076 10077 10078 10079 10080 10081 10082 10083 10084 10085 10086 10087 10088 10089 10090 10091 10092 10093 10094 10095 10096 10097
#ifdef PNG_SET_OPTION_SUPPORTED
      else if (strncmp(*argv, "--option=", 9) == 0)
      {
         /* Syntax of the argument is <option>:{on|off} */
         const char *arg = 9+*argv;
         unsigned char option=0, setting=0;

#ifdef PNG_ARM_NEON_API_SUPPORTED
         if (strncmp(arg, "arm-neon:", 9) == 0)
            option = PNG_ARM_NEON, arg += 9;

         else
#endif
         if (strncmp(arg, "max-inflate-window:", 19) == 0)
            option = PNG_MAXIMUM_INFLATE_WINDOW, arg += 19;

         else
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %s: %s: unknown option\n", *argv, arg);
            exit(99);
         }

         if (strcmp(arg, "off") == 0)
            setting = PNG_OPTION_OFF;

         else if (strcmp(arg, "on") == 0)
            setting = PNG_OPTION_ON;

         else
         {
            fprintf(stderr,
               "pngvalid: %s: %s: unknown setting (use 'on' or 'off')\n",
               *argv, arg);
            exit(99);
         }

         pm.this.options[pm.this.noptions].option = option;
         pm.this.options[pm.this.noptions++].setting = setting;
      }
#endif /* PNG_SET_OPTION_SUPPORTED */

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10098 10099 10100
      else
      {
         fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %s: unknown argument\n", *argv);
10101
         exit(99);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10102
      }
10103 10104 10105 10106 10107 10108

      if (catmore) /* consumed an extra *argv */
      {
         cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, " ");
         cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, *argv);
      }
10109
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10110

10111 10112 10113 10114
   /* If pngvalid is run with no arguments default to a reasonable set of the
    * tests.
    */
   if (pm.test_standard == 0 && pm.test_size == 0 && pm.test_transform == 0 &&
10115
      pm.ngamma_tests == 0)
10116
   {
10117 10118 10119 10120 10121
      /* Make this do all the tests done in the test shell scripts with the same
       * parameters, where possible.  The limitation is that all the progressive
       * read and interlace stuff has to be done in separate runs, so only the
       * basic 'standard' and 'size' tests are done.
       */
10122 10123 10124
      pm.test_standard = 1;
      pm.test_size = 1;
      pm.test_transform = 1;
10125
      pm.ngamma_tests = 2U;
10126 10127
   }

10128
   if (pm.ngamma_tests > 0 &&
10129
      pm.test_gamma_threshold == 0 && pm.test_gamma_transform == 0 &&
10130
      pm.test_gamma_sbit == 0 && pm.test_gamma_scale16 == 0 &&
10131
      pm.test_gamma_background == 0 && pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode == 0)
10132 10133 10134 10135
   {
      pm.test_gamma_threshold = 1;
      pm.test_gamma_transform = 1;
      pm.test_gamma_sbit = 1;
10136
      pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 1;
10137 10138
      pm.test_gamma_background = 1;
      pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 1;
10139
   }
10140

10141
   else if (pm.ngamma_tests == 0)
10142 10143 10144 10145 10146
   {
      /* Nothing to test so turn everything off: */
      pm.test_gamma_threshold = 0;
      pm.test_gamma_transform = 0;
      pm.test_gamma_sbit = 0;
10147
      pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 0;
10148 10149
      pm.test_gamma_background = 0;
      pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 0;
10150 10151
   }

10152 10153 10154
   Try
   {
      /* Make useful base images */
10155
      make_transform_images(&pm.this);
10156 10157

      /* Perform the standard and gamma tests. */
10158
      if (pm.test_standard)
10159
      {
10160
         perform_interlace_macro_validation();
10161
         perform_formatting_test(&pm.this);
10162 10163 10164
#        ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
            perform_standard_test(&pm);
#        endif
10165 10166 10167
         perform_error_test(&pm);
      }

10168 10169 10170 10171
      /* Various oddly sized images: */
      if (pm.test_size)
      {
         make_size_images(&pm.this);
10172 10173 10174
#        ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
            perform_size_test(&pm);
#        endif
10175 10176
      }

10177
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
10178 10179 10180
      /* Combinatorial transforms: */
      if (pm.test_transform)
         perform_transform_test(&pm);
10181
#endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
10182

10183
#ifdef PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED
10184
      if (pm.ngamma_tests > 0)
10185
         perform_gamma_test(&pm, summary);
10186
#endif
10187 10188
   }

10189
   Catch_anonymous
10190
   {
10191
      fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: test aborted (probably failed in cleanup)\n");
10192 10193 10194 10195
      if (!pm.this.verbose)
      {
         if (pm.this.error[0] != 0)
            fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: first error: %s\n", pm.this.error);
10196

10197 10198
         fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: run with -v to see what happened\n");
      }
10199 10200
      exit(1);
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10201

10202
   if (summary)
10203
   {
10204
      printf("%s: %s (%s point arithmetic)\n",
10205 10206 10207
         (pm.this.nerrors || (pm.this.treat_warnings_as_errors &&
            pm.this.nwarnings)) ? "FAIL" : "PASS",
         command,
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10208
#if defined(PNG_FLOATING_ARITHMETIC_SUPPORTED) || PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10500
10209
         "floating"
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10210
#else
10211
         "fixed"
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10212
#endif
10213
         );
10214 10215 10216 10217
   }

   if (memstats)
   {
10218
      printf("Allocated memory statistics (in bytes):\n"
10219 10220 10221 10222 10223 10224 10225 10226
         "\tread  %lu maximum single, %lu peak, %lu total\n"
         "\twrite %lu maximum single, %lu peak, %lu total\n",
         (unsigned long)pm.this.read_memory_pool.max_max,
         (unsigned long)pm.this.read_memory_pool.max_limit,
         (unsigned long)pm.this.read_memory_pool.max_total,
         (unsigned long)pm.this.write_memory_pool.max_max,
         (unsigned long)pm.this.write_memory_pool.max_limit,
         (unsigned long)pm.this.write_memory_pool.max_total);
10227 10228 10229 10230 10231 10232
   }

   /* Do this here to provoke memory corruption errors in memory not directly
    * allocated by libpng - not a complete test, but better than nothing.
    */
   store_delete(&pm.this);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10233 10234 10235 10236

   /* Error exit if there are any errors, and maybe if there are any
    * warnings.
    */
10237 10238
   if (pm.this.nerrors || (pm.this.treat_warnings_as_errors &&
       pm.this.nwarnings))
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10239 10240 10241
   {
      if (!pm.this.verbose)
         fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %s\n", pm.this.error);
10242

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10243
      fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %d errors, %d warnings\n", pm.this.nerrors,
10244 10245
          pm.this.nwarnings);

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10246 10247 10248
      exit(1);
   }

10249 10250 10251 10252
   /* Success case. */
   if (touch != NULL)
   {
      FILE *fsuccess = fopen(touch, "wt");
10253

10254 10255 10256 10257 10258 10259
      if (fsuccess != NULL)
      {
         int error = 0;
         fprintf(fsuccess, "PNG validation succeeded\n");
         fflush(fsuccess);
         error = ferror(fsuccess);
10260

10261 10262 10263 10264 10265 10266
         if (fclose(fsuccess) || error)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "%s: write failed\n", touch);
            exit(1);
         }
      }
10267 10268 10269 10270 10271 10272

      else
      {
         fprintf(stderr, "%s: open failed\n", touch);
         exit(1);
      }
10273 10274
   }

10275 10276 10277
   /* This is required because some very minimal configurations do not use it:
    */
   UNUSED(fail)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
10278 10279
   return 0;
}
10280
#else /* write or low level APIs not supported */
10281 10282
int main(void)
{
10283 10284
   fprintf(stderr,
      "pngvalid: no low level write support in libpng, all tests skipped\n");
10285
   /* So the test is skipped: */
10286 10287 10288 10289
#if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10601
   /* Test harness support was only added in libpng 1.6.1: */
   return 0;
#else
10290
   return 77;
10291
#endif
10292 10293
}
#endif